blob: a7dea35637448fb3f6e248f0032139244aa7d3ae [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau60e60202019-10-23 08:06:13 +02007 2019/10/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100589 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200591 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200593 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - presetenv
597 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - uid
599 - ulimit-n
600 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200601 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100602 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-options
607 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - ssl-default-server-options
610 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100611 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100614 - 51degrees-data-file
615 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200616 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200617 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200618 - wurfl-data-file
619 - wurfl-information-list
620 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200621 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200624 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200626 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100627 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100628 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100629 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200630 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200631 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200632 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200633 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 - noepoll
635 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000636 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100638 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300639 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000640 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100641 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200642 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200643 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200644 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000645 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000646 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - tune.buffers.limit
648 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200649 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200650 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100651 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200652 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200653 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200654 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100655 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200656 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200657 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100658 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100659 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100660 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.session-timeout
662 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200663 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100664 - tune.maxaccept
665 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200667 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200668 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100669 - tune.rcvbuf.client
670 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100671 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200672 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100673 - tune.sndbuf.client
674 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100675 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100676 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200677 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200679 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200680 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100681 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200682 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100683 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
685 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
686 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100687 - tune.zlib.memlevel
688 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 * Debugging
691 - debug
692 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200693
694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696------------------------------------
697
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200698ca-base <dir>
699 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200700 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
701 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703chroot <jail dir>
704 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
705 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
706 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
707 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
708 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
712 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
713 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
714 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
715 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
716 set. These sets have the format
717
718 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
719
720 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
723 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100724 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
725 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100726 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100727 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
731 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
732 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
733 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100735 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
736 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
737 on the machine's word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
741 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
742 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
743 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
744 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
745 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100746
747 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
749
750 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
751 # first 4 CPUs
752
753 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
754 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
755 # word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
762
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
764 # and so on.
765 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100769 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
771 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
772 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
773
774 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
776 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
777
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
779 # and a thread range.
780 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
781 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
783
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200784crt-base <dir>
785 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
786 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
787 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789daemon
790 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
791 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100792 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
793 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200795deviceatlas-json-file <path>
796 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200798
799deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200801 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
802
803deviceatlas-separator <char>
804 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
805 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
806
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100807deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200808 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
809 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
810 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100811
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900812external-check
813 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
814 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
815 See "option external-check".
816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817gid <number>
818 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
819 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
820 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100821 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
822 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100825hard-stop-after <time>
826 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
827
828 Arguments :
829 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
830 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
831 SIGUSR1 signal.
832
833 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
834 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
835 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
836
837 Example:
838 global
839 hard-stop-after 30s
840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841group <group name>
842 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
843 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100844
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200845log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
846 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100847 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849 configured with "log global".
850
851 <address> can be one of:
852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100853 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100854 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
855 port).
856
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100857 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
858 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
859 port).
860
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100861 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100862 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
863 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100864 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100865
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
867 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
868 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
869 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
870 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
871 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
872 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
873 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
874 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
875 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
876 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
877 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
878 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
879 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100880 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
881 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100882
883 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
884 "fd@2", see above.
885
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200886 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
887 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100888
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200889 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
890 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
891 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
892 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
893 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
894 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
895 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
896 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
897 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
898 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
900 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200901
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200902 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
903 one of the following :
904
905 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
906 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
907
908 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
909 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
910
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100911 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
912 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
913 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
914 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
915 logger consumes.
916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100917 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
918 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
919 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
920 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
921
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200922 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
923 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
924 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
925 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
926 set with <sample_size> parameter.
927
928 <sample_size>
929 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
930 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
931 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
932 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
933 (see also <ranges> parameter).
934
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100935 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100937 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
938 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
939 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
942 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
943 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
944 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200947 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
948 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
949 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
950 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
951 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
952 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200954 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100956log-send-hostname [<string>]
957 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
958 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
959 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
960 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
961 the logs.
962
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000963log-tag <string>
964 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
965 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
966 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100967 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000968
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100969lua-load <file>
970 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
971 used multiple times.
972
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100973master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200974 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
975 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
976 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100977 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200978 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
979 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100980 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
981 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
982 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
983 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
984 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200985
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100986 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200987
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200988mworker-max-reloads <number>
989 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500990 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200991 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
992 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
993 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995nbproc <number>
996 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
997 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
998 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100999 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1000 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001001 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1002 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001004nbthread <number>
1005 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001006 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1007 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1008 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1009 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1010 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001011 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1012 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1013 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1014 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1015 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1016 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1017 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001020 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1022 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1023
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024presetenv <name> <value>
1025 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1026 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1027 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1028 and "unsetenv".
1029
1030resetenv [<name> ...]
1031 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1032 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1033 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1034 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1035 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1036 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1037 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1038 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1039
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001040stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001041 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1042 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1043 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1044 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1045 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1046 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001047 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001048 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1049 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1050 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1051 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001052
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053server-state-base <directory>
1054 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001055 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1056 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057
1058server-state-file <file>
1059 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1060 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1061 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1062 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1063 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1064 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1065 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1066 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001067 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1068 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070setenv <name> <value>
1071 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1072 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1073 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1074 and "unsetenv".
1075
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001076set-dumpable
1077 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1078 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1079 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1080 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1081 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1082 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1083 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1084 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1085 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1086 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1087 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1088 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1089 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1090 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1091 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1092 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1093 expected when dying.
1094
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001095ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1097 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001098 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001099 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001100 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1101 information and recommendations see e.g.
1102 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1103 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1104 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1105 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001106
1107ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1109 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1110 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1111 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1112 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001113 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1114 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1115 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001116 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001117
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001118ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1120 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1121 keyword to see available options.
1122
1123 Example:
1124 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001125 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001126
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001127ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1129 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001130 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001131 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001132 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1133 information and recommendations see e.g.
1134 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1135 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1136 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1137 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1138 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001139
1140ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1142 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1143 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1144 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1145 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001146 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1147 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1148 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1149 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001150
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001151ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1153 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1154 keyword to see available options.
1155
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001156ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1158 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1159 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001161 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001162 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1163 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1164 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1165 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001166 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1167 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1168 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1169
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001170ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1171 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1172 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1173 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001175stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1176 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1177 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1178 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001179 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001180 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001181
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001182 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1183 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1184 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001185
1186stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1187 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1188 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001189 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001190
1191stats maxconn <connections>
1192 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1193 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001195uid <number>
1196 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1197 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1198 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1199 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1200
1201ulimit-n <number>
1202 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1203 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1204 option.
1205
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001206unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1207 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1208
1209 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1210 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1211 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1212 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1213 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1214 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1215 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1216 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1217 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1218 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220unsetenv [<name> ...]
1221 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1222 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1223 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1224 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1225 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1226 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1227 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229user <user name>
1230 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1231 See also "uid" and "group".
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001233node <name>
1234 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1235
1236 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1237 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1238 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1239 traffic.
1240
1241description <text>
1242 Add a text that describes the instance.
1243
1244 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1245 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1246 "<" and ">" characters.
1247
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100124851degrees-data-file <file path>
1249 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001250 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001251
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001252 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1254
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000125551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001256 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1257 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1258 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1259
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001261 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1262
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200126351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001264 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1265 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1266
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001267 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1269
127051degrees-cache-size <number>
1271 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1272 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1273 By default, this cache is disabled.
1274
1275 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001276 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1277
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001278wurfl-data-file <file path>
1279 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1280 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1286 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1287 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1288 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1289
1290 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1291
1292 Valid WURFL properties are:
1293 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1294
1295 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1296 device.
1297
1298 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1299 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1300
1301 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1302 particular web request.
1303
1304 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1305 used Libwurfl API version.
1306
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001307 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1308 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1309
1310 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1311 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1312
1313 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1314
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001315 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1316 with USE_WURFL=1.
1317
1318wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1319 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1320 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
1325wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1326 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1327 thus before the chroot.
1328
1329 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1330 with USE_WURFL=1.
1331
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001332wurfl-cache-size <size>
1333 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1334 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001335 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001336 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001337
1338 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1339 with USE_WURFL=1.
1340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013413.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342-----------------------
1343
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001344busy-polling
1345 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1346 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1347 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1348 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1349 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1350 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1351 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1352 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1353 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1354 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1355 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1356 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1357 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1358 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1359 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1360 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1361 "poll" pollers.
1362
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001363max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1364 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1365 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1366 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1367 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1368 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1369 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1370 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1371 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001373maxconn <number>
1374 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1375 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1376 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001377 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1378 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1379 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1380 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001381 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1382 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1383 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1384 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1385 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1386 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001388maxconnrate <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1390 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1391 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1392 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1393 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1394 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1395 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1396 fairness.
1397
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001398maxcomprate <number>
1399 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001400 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001401 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1402 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1403 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001404 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001405 default value.
1406
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001407maxcompcpuusage <number>
1408 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1409 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1410 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1411 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1412 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1413 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1414 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1415 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1416
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001417maxpipes <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1419 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1420 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1421 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1422 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1423 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1424
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001425maxsessrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1427 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1428 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1429 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1430 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1431 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1432 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1433 fairness.
1434
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001435maxsslconn <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1437 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1438 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1439 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1440 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1441 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1442 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001443 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1444 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1445 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1446 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1447 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1448 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1449 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001450
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001451maxsslrate <number>
1452 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1453 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1454 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1455 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1456 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1457 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1458 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1459 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1460 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1461 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1462
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001463maxzlibmem <number>
1464 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1465 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1466 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001467 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1468 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1469 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471noepoll
1472 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1473 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001474 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
1476nokqueue
1477 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1478 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1479 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1480
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001481noevports
1482 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1483 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1484 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1485 also "nopoll".
1486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001487nopoll
1488 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1489 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001491 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1492 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001494nosplice
1495 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001497 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001498 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001499 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1500 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1501 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1502 "option splice-response".
1503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001504nogetaddrinfo
1505 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1506 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1507
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001508noreuseport
1509 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1510 command line argument "-dR".
1511
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001512profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1513 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1514 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1515 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1516 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001517 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001518 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1519 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1520 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1521 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1522
1523 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1524 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1525 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1526 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1527 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001528 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1529 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1530 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1531 CLI.
1532
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001533spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001534 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1535 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1536 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1537 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1538 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1539 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001542 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001543 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001544 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1545 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1546 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1547 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1548 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001549 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1550 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001551 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1552 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1553 openssl configuration file uses:
1554 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1555
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001556ssl-mode-async
1557 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001558 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001559 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1560 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1561 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001562 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001563 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001564
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001565tune.buffers.limit <number>
1566 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1567 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1568 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1569 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1570 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001571 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001572 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1573 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1574 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1575 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1576 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1577 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1578 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1579 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1580 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1581
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001582tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1583 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1584 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1585 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1586 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1587
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001588tune.bufsize <number>
1589 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1590 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1591 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1592 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1593 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1594 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1595 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001596 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1597 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1598 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001599 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001600 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1601 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1602 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001603
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001604tune.chksize <number>
1605 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1606 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1607 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1608 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1609 checks whenever possible.
1610
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001611tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1612 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1613 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1614 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1615 this value. The default value is 1.
1616
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001617tune.fail-alloc
1618 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1619 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1620 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1621 gracefully.
1622
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001623tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1624 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1625 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1626 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1627 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1628 change it.
1629
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001630tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1631 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001632 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1633 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001634 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1635 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1636 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1637 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1638 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1639
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001640tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1641 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1642 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1643 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1644 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1645 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1646 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1647 recommended not to change this value.
1648
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001649tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1650 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1651 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1652 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1653 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1654 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1655 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1656 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1657
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001658tune.http.cookielen <number>
1659 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1660 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1661 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1662 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1663 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1664 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1665 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1666 to change this value.
1667
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001668tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1670 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001671 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001673 configuration directives too.
1674 The default value is 1024.
1675
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001676tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1677 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1678 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1679 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1680 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1681 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1682 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001683 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1684 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1685 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001686
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001687tune.idletimer <timeout>
1688 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1689 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1690 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1691 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1692 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1693 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001694 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001695 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001696 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1697
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001698tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1699 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1700 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1701 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1702 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1703 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1704 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1705 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1706 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1707 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1708
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001709tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1710 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001711 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001712 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1713 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001715 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1716 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1717
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001718tune.lua.maxmem
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1720 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1721 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1722 memory.
1723
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001724tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1725 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001726 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1727 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001729
1730tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1731 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1732 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1733 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1734 check servers.
1735
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001736tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1737 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1738 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1739 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001742tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1744 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1745 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1746 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1747 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1748 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1749 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1750 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1751 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1752 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001753
1754tune.maxpollevents <number>
1755 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1756 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1757 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1758 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1759 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1760
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001761tune.maxrewrite <number>
1762 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1763 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1764 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1765 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1766 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1767 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1768 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1769 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1770 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1771 bufsize.
1772
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001773tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1774 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1775 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1776 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1777 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1778 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1779 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1780 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1781 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1782 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001783 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1784 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001785 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1786 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1787 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1788 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1789 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1790 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1791 setting this parameter to 0.
1792
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001793tune.pipesize <number>
1794 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1795 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1796 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1797 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1798 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1799 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1800
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001801tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1802 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1803 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1804 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1805 default is 20.
1806
1807tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1808 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1809 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1810 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1811 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1812 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1813 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001814 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001815
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001816tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1817tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1818 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1819 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1820 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001821 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001822 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001823 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1824 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1825
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001826tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001828 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1829 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1830 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1831 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1832
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001833tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001834 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001835 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1836 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1837
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001838tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1839tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1840 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1841 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1842 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001843 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001844 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001845 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1846 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1847 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1848 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1849 notifying haproxy again.
1850
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001851tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001852 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1853 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1854 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001855 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001856 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001857 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001858 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1859 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1860 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001861 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1862 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001863
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001864tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001865 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001866 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1867 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1868 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1869 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1870 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1871
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001872tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1873 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001874 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001875 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1876 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1877 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1878 being used for too long.
1879
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001880tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1881 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1882 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1883 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1884 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1885 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1886 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1887 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1888 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1889 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1890 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001891 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001892 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001893
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001894tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1895 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1896 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1897 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1898 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1899 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1900 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1901 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001902 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1903 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001904
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001905tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1906 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1907 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1908 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1909 1000 entries.
1910
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001911tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1912 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1913 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1914 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1915
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001916tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001917tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001918tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1919tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1920tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001921 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1922 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1923 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1924 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1925 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1926 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1927 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1928 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001929
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001930 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1931 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1932 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1933 all available space is consumed.
1934 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1935 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1936 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001937
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001938tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1939 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001940 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001941 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001942 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001943 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1944
1945tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1946 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1947 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001948 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1949 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019513.3. Debugging
1952--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001953
1954debug
1955 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1956 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1957 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1958 system startup.
1959
1960quiet
1961 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1962 line argument "-q".
1963
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019653.4. Userlists
1966--------------
1967It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1968http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1969it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1970
1971userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001972 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001973 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1974
1975group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001976 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1978 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1979
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001980user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1981 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001982 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1983 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001984 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1985 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1986 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1987 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001988
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001989 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1990 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1991 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1992 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1993 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1994 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1995 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1996 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1997 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001998
1999 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002000 userlist L1
2001 group G1 users tiger,scott
2002 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002004 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2005 user scott insecure-password elgato
2006 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002008 userlist L2
2009 group G1
2010 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002011
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002012 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2013 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2014 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002015
2016 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002018
20193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002020----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002021It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2022several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2023instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2024values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2025automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2026In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2027using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2028tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2029reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2030Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2031that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2032each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002033
2034peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002035 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002036 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2037
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002038bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2039 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2040 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2041
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002042disabled
2043 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2044 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2045 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2046
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002047default-bind [param*]
2048 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2049
2050default-server [param*]
2051 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2052
2053 Arguments:
2054 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2055 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2056 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2057 details.
2058
2059
2060 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2061
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002062enable
2063 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002065peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002066 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2067 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2068 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2069 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2070 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2071 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2072
2073 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2074 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2075
2076 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2077 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2078 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2079 across all peers.
2080
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002081 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2082 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002083
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002084 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2085 "server" keyword explanation below).
2086
2087server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002088 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002089 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2090 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2091 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2092 of this "peers" section).
2093 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2094
2095
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002097 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002098 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002099 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2100 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2101 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002102
2103 backend mybackend
2104 mode tcp
2105 balance roundrobin
2106 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2107 stick on src
2108
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002109 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2110 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002111
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002112 Example:
2113 peers mypeers
2114 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2115 default-server ssl verify none
2116 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2117 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002118
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002119
2120table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2121 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2122
2123 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2124 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002125 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002126 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2127 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2128 "stick-table" keyword).
2129
2130 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2131 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2132 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2133 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2134 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2135 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2136 of the stick-table name as follows:
2137
2138 peers mypeers
2139 peer A ...
2140 peer B ...
2141 table t1 ...
2142
2143 frontend fe1
2144 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2145
2146 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2147 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2148
2149 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2150 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2151 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2152 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2153 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2154 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2155 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2156
2157 peers mypeers
2158 peer A ...
2159 peer B ...
2160 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2161
2162 backend t1
2163 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2164
2165 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2166 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2167 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2168
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021693.6. Mailers
2170------------
2171It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2172If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2173in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2174
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002175mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002176 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2177 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2178
2179mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2180 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2181
2182 Example:
2183 mailers mymailers
2184 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2185 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2186
2187 backend mybackend
2188 mode tcp
2189 balance roundrobin
2190
2191 email-alert mailers mymailers
2192 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2193 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2194
2195 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2196 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2197
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002198timeout mail <time>
2199 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2200 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2201 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2202 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2203
2204 Example:
2205 mailers mymailers
2206 timeout mail 20s
2207 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002208
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022093.7. Programs
2210-------------
2211In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2212master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2213managed the same way as the workers.
2214
2215During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2216sequence as a worker:
2217
2218 - the master is re-executed
2219 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2220 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2221 instance of the program
2222
2223During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2224
2225program <name>
2226 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2227 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2228 the management guide).
2229
2230command <command> [arguments*]
2231 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2232 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2233 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2234 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2235
2236option start-on-reload
2237no option start-on-reload
2238 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2239 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2240 program section.
2241
2242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022434. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002244----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002246Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002247 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002248 - frontend <name>
2249 - backend <name>
2250 - listen <name>
2251
2252A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2253its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2254section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002256
2257A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2258connections.
2259
2260A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2261to forward incoming connections.
2262
2263A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2264parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2265
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002266All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2267'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2268case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2269
2270Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2271logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2272proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2273However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2274name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2275
2276Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2277and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002278bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2280modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2281arbitrary criteria.
2282
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002283In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2284a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002285the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002286
2287 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2288 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2289 between responses and new requests.
2290
2291 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2292 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2293 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002294 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2295 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2296 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2297 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002298
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002299 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2300 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2301 client-facing connection remains open.
2302
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002303 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2304 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002305
2306The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2307frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2308following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002309weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002310
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002311 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002312
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002313 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2314 ----+-----+-----+----
2315 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2316 ----+-----+-----+----
2317 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2318 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2319 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2320 ----+-----+-----+----
2321 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2326--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002328The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2329limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2330they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2331limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002332marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002333option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002334and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2335with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2336specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002338
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002339 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2340------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2341acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002342backlog X X X -
2343balance X - X X
2344bind - X X -
2345bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002346block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002347capture cookie - X X -
2348capture request header - X X -
2349capture response header - X X -
2350clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002351compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002352contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2353cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002354declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002355default-server X - X X
2356default_backend X X X -
2357description - X X X
2358disabled X X X X
2359dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002360email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002361email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002362email-alert mailers X X X X
2363email-alert myhostname X X X X
2364email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002365enabled X X X X
2366errorfile X X X X
2367errorloc X X X X
2368errorloc302 X X X X
2369-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2370errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002371force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002372filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373fullconn X - X X
2374grace X X X X
2375hash-type X - X X
2376http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002377http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002378http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002379http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002380http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002381http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002382http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002383id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002384ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002385load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002386log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002387log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002388log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002389log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002390max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002391maxconn X X X -
2392mode X X X X
2393monitor fail - X X -
2394monitor-net X X X -
2395monitor-uri X X X -
2396option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2397option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2398option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2399option allbackups (*) X - X X
2400option checkcache (*) X - X X
2401option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2402option contstats (*) X X X -
2403option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2404option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002405-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2406option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002407option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002408option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002409option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002410option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002411option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002412option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002413option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002414option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002415option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002416option httpchk X - X X
2417option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002418option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002419option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002420option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002421option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002422option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2424option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2425option logasap (*) X X X -
2426option mysql-check X - X X
2427option nolinger (*) X X X X
2428option originalto X X X X
2429option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002430option pgsql-check X - X X
2431option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002432option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002433option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434option smtpchk X - X X
2435option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2436option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2437option splice-request (*) X X X X
2438option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002439option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002440option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2441option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2442-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002443option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002444option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2445option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2446option tcpka X X X X
2447option tcplog X X X X
2448option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002449external-check command X - X X
2450external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002451persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2452rate-limit sessions X X X -
2453redirect - X X X
2454redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2455redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002456reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2457reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2458reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2459reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2460reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2461reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2462reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2463reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2464reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2465reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2466reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2467reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002468-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002469reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002471retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002472rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2473rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2474rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2475rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2476rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2477rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2478rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002479server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002480server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002481server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002482source X - X X
2483srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002484stats admin - X X X
2485stats auth X X X X
2486stats enable X X X X
2487stats hide-version X X X X
2488stats http-request - X X X
2489stats realm X X X X
2490stats refresh X X X X
2491stats scope X X X X
2492stats show-desc X X X X
2493stats show-legends X X X X
2494stats show-node X X X X
2495stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002496-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2497stick match - - X X
2498stick on - - X X
2499stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002500stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002501stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002502tcp-check connect - - X X
2503tcp-check expect - - X X
2504tcp-check send - - X X
2505tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002506tcp-request connection - X X -
2507tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002508tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002509tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002510tcp-response content - - X X
2511tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002512timeout check X - X X
2513timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002514timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002515timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2516timeout connect X - X X
2517timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2518timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2519timeout http-request X X X X
2520timeout queue X - X X
2521timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002522timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002523timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2524timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002525timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002526transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002527unique-id-format X X X -
2528unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002529use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002530use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002531------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2532 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025354.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2536---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002537
2538This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2539
2540
2541acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2542 Declare or complete an access list.
2543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2544 no | yes | yes | yes
2545 Example:
2546 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2547 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2548 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2549
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002550 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
2552
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002553backlog <conns>
2554 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2556 yes | yes | yes | no
2557 Arguments :
2558 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2559 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002560 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002561
2562 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2563 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2564 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2565 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2566 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2567 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2568 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2569 backlog parameter.
2570
2571 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2572 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2573 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2574
2575 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2576
2577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002578balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002579balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2582 yes | no | yes | yes
2583 Arguments :
2584 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2585 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2586 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2587 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2588
2589 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2590 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2591 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2592 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002593 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002594 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002595 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2596 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2597 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2598 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2599 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2600 it, so that you don't worry.
2601
2602 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2603 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2604 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2605 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2606 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2607 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2608 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2609 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002611 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2612 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2613 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2614 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2615 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2616 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2617 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2618 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2619
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002620 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002621 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002622 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2623 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002624 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002625 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2626 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2627 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2628 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2629 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002630 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2631 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2632 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2633 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2634 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2635 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002636
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2638 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2639 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2640 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2641 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2642 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2643 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2644 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002645 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002647 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2648 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2649 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002651 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2652 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2653 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2654 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2655 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2656 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2657 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2658 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2659 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2660 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2661 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2662 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002663
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002664 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002665 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2666 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2667 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2668 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2669 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2670 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2671 URIs start with a leading "/".
2672
2673 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2674 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2675 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2676 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002679 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2680
2681 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002682 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2683 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002684 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2685 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2686 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2687 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002688 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002689 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2690 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002691
2692 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2693 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2694 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2695 server will receive the request.
2696
2697 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2698 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2699 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2700 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2701 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2703 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2704 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002706 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2707 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2708 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2709 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2710 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002712 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002713 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2714 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2715 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2716
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2720
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002721 random
2722 random(<draws>)
2723 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002724 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2725 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2726 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2727 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002728 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2729 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2730 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2731 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2732 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2733 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2734 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2735 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2736 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2737 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2738 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2739 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2740 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2741 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2742 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2743 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2744 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2745 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2746 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2747 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002748
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002749 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002750 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002751 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2752 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2753 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2754 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2755 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2756 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002757 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002758 used instead.
2759
2760 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2761 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2762 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2763 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2764
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002765 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2766 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2767 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2768
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002769 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002772 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2773 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002774
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002775 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2776 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2777 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002779 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002780 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002781 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2782 NTLM relies on.
2783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784 Examples :
2785 balance roundrobin
2786 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002787 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002788 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2789 balance hdr(host)
2790 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002791
2792 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2793 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002795 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002796 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2797 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2798 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2799 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2800
2801 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2802 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2803 defaults to 16 kB.
2804
2805 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2806 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2807
2808 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2809 Round Robin.
2810
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002811 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002812 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2813 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2814 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2815
2816 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2817
2818 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002819 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2821 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2822 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002824 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825
2826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002827bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2828bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002829 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2831 no | yes | yes | no
2832 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002833 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2834 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2835 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2836 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002837 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002838 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2839 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2840 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2841 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2842 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2843 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2844 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002845 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2846 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2847 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2848 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2849 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2850 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2851 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002852 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2853 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2854 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002855 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2856 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2857 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2858 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002859 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2860 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2861 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002862
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002863 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2864 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002865 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2866 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2867 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002868 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2869 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2870 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2871 the range.
2872
2873 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2874 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2875 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2876 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2877 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2878 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2879 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002880 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002881 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002883 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002884 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002885 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2886 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2887 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2888 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2889 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2890 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2891
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002892 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2893 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2894 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2895 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2898 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2899 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2900 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2901 in a frontend.
2902
2903 Example :
2904 listen http_proxy
2905 bind :80,:443
2906 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002907 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002908
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002909 listen http_https_proxy
2910 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002911 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002912
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002913 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2914 bind ipv6@:80
2915 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2916 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2917
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002918 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002919 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002920
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002921 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2922 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2923 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2924 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2925 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2926
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002927 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002928 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929
2930
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002931bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002932 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments :
2936 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2937 may be used to override a default value.
2938
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002939 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002940 option may be combined with other numbers.
2941
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002942 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002943 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2944 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2945 missing from all processes.
2946
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002947 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002948 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002949 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2950 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2951 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2952 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2953 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002954 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002955
2956 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2957 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2958 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2959 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2960 and 'even' instances.
2961
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002962 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2963 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2964 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2965 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002966
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002967 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2968 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2969
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002970 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2971 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2972 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2973
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002974 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2975 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2976
2977 Example :
2978 listen app_ip1
2979 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002980 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002981
2982 listen app_ip2
2983 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002984 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002985
2986 listen management
2987 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002988 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002990 listen management
2991 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2992 bind-process 1-4
2993
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002994 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002995
2996
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002997block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 no | yes | yes | yes
3001
3002 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3003 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003004 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003005 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003007 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3008 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3009 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003011 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3012 "http-request deny" instead.
3013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014 Example:
3015 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3016 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3017 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003018 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3019 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3020 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003021
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003022 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3023 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3024 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003025
3026capture cookie <name> len <length>
3027 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3029 no | yes | yes | no
3030 Arguments :
3031 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3032 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3033 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3034 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003035 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
3037 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3038 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3039 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3040 right if it exceeds <length>.
3041
3042 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3043 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3044 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3045 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3046
3047 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3048 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3049 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3050
3051 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3052 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3053 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003054 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3055 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3056 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003057
3058 Example:
3059 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3060
3061 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003062 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063
3064
3065capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003066 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3068 no | yes | yes | no
3069 Arguments :
3070 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003071 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3073 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3074 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3075
3076 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3077 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3078 it exceeds <length>.
3079
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003080 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003081 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3082 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003083 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3084 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3085 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3086 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003087 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003088 environments to find where the request came from.
3089
3090 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3091 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3092 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3093 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003095 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3096 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3097 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3098 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3099 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003100
3101 Example:
3102 capture request header Host len 15
3103 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003104 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003106 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107 about logging.
3108
3109
3110capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003111 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3113 no | yes | yes | no
3114 Arguments :
3115 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003116 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3118 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3119 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3120
3121 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3122 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3123 it exceeds <length>.
3124
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003125 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3127 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3128 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003129 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3130 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3131 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3132 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003133
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003134 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3135 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3136 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3137 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3138 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139
3140 Example:
3141 capture response header Content-length len 9
3142 capture response header Location len 15
3143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003144 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 about logging.
3146
3147
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003148clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3151 yes | yes | yes | no
3152 Arguments :
3153 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3155 as explained at the top of this document.
3156
3157 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3158 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3159 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3160 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3161 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3162 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3163 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3164 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003165 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003167 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
3169 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3170 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3171 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3172 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3173 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3174 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3175
3176 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3177 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3178
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3180 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003182compression algo <algorithm> ...
3183compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003184compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003185 Enable HTTP compression.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 yes | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003189 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3190 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3191 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3192
3193 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003194 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3195 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3196 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003197
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003198 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003199 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003200
3201 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3202 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3203 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3204 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3205 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003206 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003207
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003208 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3209 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3210 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3211 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3212 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3213 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3214 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003215 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003216
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003217 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003218 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003219 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3220 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3221 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3222 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3223 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003224
3225 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3226 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3227 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3228 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3229 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003230 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3231 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3232 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3233 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3234 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003235 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3236 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003237
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003238 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003239 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3240 "Accept-Encoding" header
3241 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003242 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003243 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3244 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3245 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3246 "multipart"
3247 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3248 header
3249 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3250 and later
3251 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3252 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003253 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003254
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003255 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003256
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003257 Examples :
3258 compression algo gzip
3259 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003261
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003262contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003263 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | no | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
3267 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3268 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3269 as explained at the top of this document.
3270
3271 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003272 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003273 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003274 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3276 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3277 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3278
3279 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3280 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3281 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3282 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3283 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3284 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3285
3286 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3287 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3288 instead.
3289
3290 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3291 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3292
3293
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003294cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003295 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3296 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003297 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3300 yes | no | yes | yes
3301 Arguments :
3302 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3303 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3304 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3305 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3306 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3307 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003308 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3310 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3311
3312 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3313 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3314 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3315 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3316 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3317 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003318 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3319 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003320 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003321 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3322 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323
3324 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003325 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003326
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003327 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003328 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003329 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003331 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3332 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3333 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3334 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3335 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3336 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3337 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
3339 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3340 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3341 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3342 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3343 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3344 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3345 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3346 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3347 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003348 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003349 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3350 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3351 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003352
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003353 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3354 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3355 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003356 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3357 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3358 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3359 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003360 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3361 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3362 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363
3364 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3365 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3366 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3367 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3368 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3369 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3370 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3371 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3372 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3373
3374 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3375 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3376 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3377 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3378 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3379 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3380 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3381 persistence cookie in the cache.
3382 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3383
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003384 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3385 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3386 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3387 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3388 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003389 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003390 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3391 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3392 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3393 they logout.
3394
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003395 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3396 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3397 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3398 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3399
3400 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3401 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3402 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3403 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3404 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3405 this attribute.
3406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003407 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003408 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003409 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3410 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3411 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3412 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3413 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3414 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003415
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003416 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3417 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3418 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3419 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3420 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3421 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3422 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3423 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003424 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003425 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3426 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3427 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3428 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3429 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3430 the site.
3431
3432 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3433 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3434 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3435 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3436 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3437 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3438 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3439 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3440 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3441 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3442 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3443 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3444 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003445 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003446 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3447 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3448
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003449 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3450 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3451 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3452 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3453 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3454 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3457 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3458 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3459 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003460
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461 Examples :
3462 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3463 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3464 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003467 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003469
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003470declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3471 Declares a capture slot.
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 no | yes | yes | no
3474 Arguments:
3475 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3476
3477 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3478 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3479 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3480 for use in the response.
3481
3482 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003483 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003484 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3485
3486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003487default-server [param*]
3488 Change default options for a server in a backend
3489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3490 yes | no | yes | yes
3491 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003492 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3493 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3494 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3495 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003496
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003497 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003498 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3499
3500 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003502
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003503default_backend <backend>
3504 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | no
3507 Arguments :
3508 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3509
3510 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3511 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3512 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3513 will catch all undetermined requests.
3514
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 Example :
3516
3517 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3518 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3519 default_backend dynamic
3520
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003521 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003524description <string>
3525 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3527 no | yes | yes | yes
3528 Arguments : string
3529
3530 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3531 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3532 it describes.
3533 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3534
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536disabled
3537 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | yes | yes | yes
3540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3543 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3544 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3545 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3546 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3547 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3548 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3549
3550 See also : "enabled"
3551
3552
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003553dispatch <address>:<port>
3554 Set a default server address
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003558
3559 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3560 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3561 during start-up.
3562
3563 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3564 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3565 possible with normal servers.
3566
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003567 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003568 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3569 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3570 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3571 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3572
3573 See also : "server"
3574
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003575
3576dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3577 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3579 yes | no | yes | yes
3580 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3581
3582 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003583 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003584 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3585 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003586 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003587 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003588
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003589enabled
3590 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3592 yes | yes | yes | yes
3593 Arguments : none
3594
3595 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3596 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3597
3598 See also : "disabled"
3599
3600
3601errorfile <code> <file>
3602 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | yes | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003607 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3608 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609
3610 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003611 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003612 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003613 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3614 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615
3616 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3617 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3618 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3619
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003620 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003622 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3623 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3624 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3625 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3626
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003627 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3628 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003630 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3631 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3632 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3635 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3636 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003637 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3639
3640 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3641
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003642 Example :
3643 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003644 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003645 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3646 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003648
3649errorloc <code> <url>
3650errorloc302 <code> <url>
3651 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3653 yes | yes | yes | yes
3654 Arguments :
3655 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003656 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3657 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003658
3659 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3660 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3661 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3662 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003663 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003664
3665 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3666 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3667 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3668
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003669 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3670
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003671 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3672 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3673 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3674 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003675 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003676 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3677 request.
3678
3679 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3680
3681
3682errorloc303 <code> <url>
3683 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | yes
3686 Arguments :
3687 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003688 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3689 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690
3691 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3692 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3693 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3694 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003695 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003696
3697 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3698 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3699 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3700
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003701 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003703 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3704 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3705 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3706 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003707 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708
3709 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3710
3711
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003712email-alert from <emailaddr>
3713 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003714 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | yes | yes | yes
3717
3718 Arguments :
3719
3720 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3721
3722 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3723 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3724
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003725 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003726 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3727 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003728
3729
3730email-alert level <level>
3731 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3732 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3733 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3734 yes | yes | yes | yes
3735
3736 Arguments :
3737
3738 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3739 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3740 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3741
3742 By default level is alert
3743
3744 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3745 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3746 for the proxy.
3747
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003748 Alerts are sent when :
3749
3750 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3751 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3752 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3753 is notice or lower
3754 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3755 and a health check status update occurs
3756
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003757 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3758 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003759 section 3.6 about mailers.
3760
3761
3762email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3763 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3764 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | yes | yes | yes
3766
3767 Arguments :
3768
3769 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3770
3771 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3772 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3773
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003774 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3775 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003776
3777
3778email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3779 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3780 mailers.
3781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | yes | yes | yes
3783
3784 Arguments :
3785
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003786 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003787
3788 By default the systems hostname is used.
3789
3790 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3791 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3792 for the proxy.
3793
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003794 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3795 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003796
3797
3798email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003799 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003800 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3801 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | yes
3803
3804 Arguments :
3805
3806 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3807
3808 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3809 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3810
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003811 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003812 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3813
3814
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003815force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3816 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003818 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003819
3820 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3821 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3822 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3823 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3824 marked down for maintenance operations.
3825
3826 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3827 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3828 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3829 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3830 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3831 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3832 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3833 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3834 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3835
3836 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3837 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3838 is used.
3839
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003840 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003841 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003842
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003843
3844filter <name> [param*]
3845 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3847 no | yes | yes | yes
3848 Arguments :
3849 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3850 referenced in section 9.
3851
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003852 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003853 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003854 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3855 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003856
3857 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3858 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3859
3860 Example:
3861 listen
3862 bind *:80
3863
3864 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3865 filter compression
3866 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3867
3868 compression algo gzip
3869 compression offload
3870
3871 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3872
3873 See also : section 9.
3874
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003876fullconn <conns>
3877 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
3880 Arguments :
3881 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3882 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3883
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003884 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003885 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003886 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003887 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3888 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3889 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3890 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3891 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003892 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003893
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003894 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3895 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003896 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3897 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3898 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003900 Example :
3901 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3902 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3903 # connections.
3904 backend dynamic
3905 fullconn 10000
3906 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3907 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3908
3909 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3910
3911
3912grace <time>
3913 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003916 Arguments :
3917 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3918 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3919 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3920
3921 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3922 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003923 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003924 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3925
3926 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3927 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3928 simplify it.
3929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003930
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003931hash-balance-factor <factor>
3932 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | no | no | yes
3935 Arguments :
3936 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3937 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003938 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003939
3940 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3941 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3942 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3943 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3944 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3945 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3946 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3947
3948 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3949 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3950 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3951 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3952 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3953
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003954 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3955 consistent hashing mechanism.
3956
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003957 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3958
3959
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003960hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003961 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | no | yes | yes
3964 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003965 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3966 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003967
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003968 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3969 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3970 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3971 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3972 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3973 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3974 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3975 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3976 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3977 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003978
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003979 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3980 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3981 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3982 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3983 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3984 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3985 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3986 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3987 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3988 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3989 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3990 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3991 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003992 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3993 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003994
3995 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3996
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003997 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003998 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3999 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4000 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004001 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4002 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4003 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004004
4005 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4006 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004007 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4008 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4009 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4010 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4011
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004012 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4013 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4014 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4015 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4016 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4017 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4018 parameter.
4019
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004020 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4021 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4022 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4023 used on strings.
4024
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004025 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4026
4027 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4028 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4029 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4030 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4031 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4032 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4033 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4034 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4035 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4036 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4037 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4038 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004039
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004040 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4041 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4042 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004043
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004044 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004045
4046
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047http-check disable-on-404
4048 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004050 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004051 Arguments : none
4052
4053 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4054 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4055 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4056 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4057 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4058 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4059 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4060 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004061 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4062 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4063 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4064
4065 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4066
4067
4068http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004069 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004071 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004072 Arguments :
4073 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4074 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004075 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004076 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4077 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4078 details on the supported keywords.
4079
4080 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4081 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4082 with the usual backslash ('\').
4083
4084 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4085 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4086 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4087 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4088 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4089
4090 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004091 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4093 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4094 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4095
4096 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004097 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004098 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4099 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4100 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4101 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4102
4103 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004104 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004105 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4106 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4107 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4108 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4109 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004110 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004111 trace).
4112
4113 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004114 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004115 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4116 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4117 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4118 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4119 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004120 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004121
4122 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4123 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4124 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4125 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4126 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4127 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4128 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4129 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4130
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004131 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4132 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4133 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4134
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004135 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4136 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4137
4138 Examples :
4139 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004140 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004141
4142 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004143 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004144
4145 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004146 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004147
4148 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004149 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004150
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004151 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004152
4153
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004154http-check send-state
4155 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4157 yes | no | yes | yes
4158 Arguments : none
4159
4160 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4161 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4162 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4163 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4164 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4165
4166 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4167 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4168 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4169 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4170 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004171 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4172 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4173 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4174
4175 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4176 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4177 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4178
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004179 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4180 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4181 checked in multiple backends.
4182
4183 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4184 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4185
4186 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4187 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4188 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4189 one fails.
4190
4191 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4192 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4193 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4194
4195 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4196 server's queue.
4197
4198 Example of a header received by the application server :
4199 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4200 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4201
4202 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204
4205http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004206 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4207
4208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4209 no | yes | yes | yes
4210
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004211 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4212 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4213 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4214 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4215 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4218 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004222 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4223 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4224 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4225 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4228 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4229 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4230 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232 Example:
4233 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4234 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4235 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237 http-request allow if nagios
4238 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4239 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4240 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 Example:
4243 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4244 acl add path /addacl
4245 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4250 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 Example:
4253 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4254 acl setmap path /setmap
4255 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004257 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004259 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4260 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4263 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004265http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4268 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4269 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4270 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4271 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4272 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4273 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4274 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4279 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4280 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4281 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4282 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4283 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4284 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4285 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4290 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4296 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4297 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4298 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4299 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 Example:
4302 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4303 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004304
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004305http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4310 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004312 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4313 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4314 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4315 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4316 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4317 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4318 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4319 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4320 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4323 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4324 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4325 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4326 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4327 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4332 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4333 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4334 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4335 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4345 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4346 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4347 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4348 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4349 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4354 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4355 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4356 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4357 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004358
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004359http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4360 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4361 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4362 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4363
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004364http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4365
4366 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4367 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4368 pointed by <resolvers>.
4369 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4370 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4371 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4372 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4373 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4374 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4375 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4376 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4377 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4378 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4379 to 0.0.0.0.
4380
4381 Example:
4382 resolvers mydns
4383 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4384 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4385 timeout retry 1s
4386 hold valid 10s
4387 hold nx 3s
4388 hold other 3s
4389 hold obsolete 0s
4390 accepted_payload_size 8192
4391
4392 frontend fe
4393 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4394 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4395 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4396
4397 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4398 # which mean DNS resolution error
4399 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4400
4401 default_backend be
4402
4403 backend b_503
4404 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4405 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4406 # 503 error page to end users
4407
4408 backend be
4409 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4410 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4411 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4412 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4413 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4414
4415 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4416 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4417
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004418http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4419
4420 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4421 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4422 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4423 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004424 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4425 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004426
4427 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4432 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4433 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4434 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4435 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004437http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004439 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4440 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4441 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4442 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4448 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4449 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4450 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4451 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4452 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4453 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4454 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004456 Example:
4457 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004459 # applied to:
4460 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 # outputs:
4463 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004465 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004466
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004467http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4469
4470 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4471 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4472 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4473 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4474 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4475 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4476 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4477 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4478 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4479 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4480 match.
4481
4482 Example:
4483 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4484 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4485
4486 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4487 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4488
4489 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4490 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4491 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4492 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4495 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4498 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4499 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4500 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 Example:
4503 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 # applied to:
4506 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004508 # outputs:
4509 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4512http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004514 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4516 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4521 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4522 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004524http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4527 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4528 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4529 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4530 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004532 Arguments:
4533 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4534 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536 Example:
4537 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4538 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004540 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4541 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004543http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004545 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4546 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4547 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004549 Arguments:
4550 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4551 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004553 Example:
4554 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4555 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004556
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004557 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4558 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4559 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004561http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004563 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4564 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4565 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4566 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4567 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004569 Example:
4570 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4571 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4572 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4578 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4583 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4584 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4585 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4586 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4589 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004591 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4592 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4593 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4594 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4595 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4596 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4597 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4598 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4599 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004601http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004603 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4604 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4605 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4606 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4607 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4608 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4609 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004611http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004613 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4614 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4615 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004617http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4620 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4621 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4622 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4623 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4624 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4625 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4626 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004630 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4631 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4632 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4633 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4634 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4635 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 Example :
4638 # prepend the host name before the path
4639 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4644 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4645 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4646 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4647 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004649http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004651 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4652 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4653 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4654 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4655 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4656 values have higher priority.
4657 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4658 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4659 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4660 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4661 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004663http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4666 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4667 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4668 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4669 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4670 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4671 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004674
4675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004676 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4677 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4680 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4681 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4682 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4683 privacy.
4684
4685 Arguments :
4686 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4687 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004688
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004689 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004690 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4691 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4692
4693 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4694 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4695
4696http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4697
4698 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4699 expression.
4700
4701 Arguments:
4702 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4703 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004704
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004705 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4707 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4708
4709 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4710 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4711 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4712
4713http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4716 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4717 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4718 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4719 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4720 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4721 information from the request.
4722
4723 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4724
4725http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4726
4727 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4728 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4729 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4730 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4731 path and the query string.
4732 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4733
4734http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4735
4736 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4737 inline.
4738
4739 Arguments:
4740 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4741 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4745 (request and response)
4746 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4747 processing
4748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4749 processing
4750 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4751 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4752 and '_'.
4753
4754 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4755 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004756
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004757 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004758 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004760http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4761 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004763 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4764 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4765 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4766 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4767 agent name must be used.
4768
4769 Arguments:
4770 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4771
4772 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4773 configuration.
4774
4775http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4776
4777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4778 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4779 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4780 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4781 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4782 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4783 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4784 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4785 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4786 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4787 action.
4788 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4789 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4790 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4791 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4792 you fully understand how it works.
4793
4794http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4795
4796 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4797 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4798 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4799 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4800 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4801 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4802 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4803 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4804 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4805 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4806 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4807 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4808 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4809
4810http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4815 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4816 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4817 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4818 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4819 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4820 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4821 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4822 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4823 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4824 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4825 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4826
4827 Arguments :
4828 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4829 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4830 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4831 select which table entry to update the counters.
4832
4833 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4834 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4835 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4836 that table until the session ends.
4837
4838 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4839 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4840 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4841 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4842 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4843 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4844 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4845 useful information.
4846
4847 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4848 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4849 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4850 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4851 checks that make use of it.
4852
4853http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4854
4855 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004856
4857 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004858 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004860http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004862 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4863 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4864 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004865
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004867http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004868 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4869
4870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4871 no | yes | yes | yes
4872
4873 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4874 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4875 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4876 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4877 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4878 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4881 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004882
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004883 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004884
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004885 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4886 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4887 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4888 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004889
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004890 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4891 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4892 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4893 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 Example:
4896 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4901 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004903 Example:
4904 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4909 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004911 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4912 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004914http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004916 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4917 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4918 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4919 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4920 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4921 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4922 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4923 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4928 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4929 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4930 example, or to pass some internal information.
4931 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4932 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4933 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004935http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4938 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004939
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004940http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004942 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004946 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4947 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4948 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4949 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4950 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4951 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4952 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4955 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4956 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4957 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4958 keyword.
4959 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4960 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4965 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4966 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4967 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4968 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4969 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004973 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004975http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004977 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4978 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4979 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4980 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4981 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4982 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004984http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4987 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004989http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004991 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4992 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4993 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4994 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4995 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4996 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004998http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005000
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005001 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
5002 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
5003 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
5004 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
5005 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
5006 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
5007 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
5008 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 Example:
5011 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005013 # applied to:
5014 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005016 # outputs:
5017 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005019 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005024 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5025 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
5026 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
5027 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005029 Example:
5030 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005032 # applied to:
5033 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035 # outputs:
5036 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5039http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5042 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5043 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005045http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5048 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5049 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005051http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005053 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5054 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5055 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5056 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5057 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005059 Arguments:
5060 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5063 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005067 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5068 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5069 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5072
5073 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5074 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5075 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5076 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5077 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5078
5079http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5080
5081 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5082 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5083 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5084 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5085 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5086 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5087 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5088 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5089 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5090
5091http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5092
5093 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5094 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5095 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5096 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5097 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5098 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5099 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5100
5101http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5102
5103 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5104 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5105 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5106 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5107 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5108 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5109 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5110 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5111
5112http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5113 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5114
5115 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5116 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5117 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5118 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005119
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5122 http-response set-status 431
5123 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5124 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005125
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005126http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5129 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5130 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5131 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5132 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5133 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5134 based on some information from the request.
5135
5136 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5137
5138http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5139
5140 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5141 inline.
5142
5143 Arguments:
5144 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5145 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5146 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5147 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5148 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5149 (request and response)
5150 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5151 processing
5152 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5153 processing
5154 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5155 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5156 and '_'.
5157
5158 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5159 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005160
5161 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005166 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5167 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5168 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5169 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5170 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5171 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5172 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5173 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5174 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5175 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5176 action.
5177 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5178 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5179 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5180 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5181 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005183http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5185http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5188 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5189 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5190 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5191 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5192 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5193
5194http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5195
5196 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5197 about <var-name>.
5198
5199 Example:
5200 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5201
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005202
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005203http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5204 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5205
5206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
5208
5209 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005210 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5211 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5212 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005213
5214 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5215
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005216 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5217 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5218 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5219 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5220 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5221 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5222 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5223 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5224 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5225 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005226
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005227 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5228 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5229 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5230 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5231 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5232 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5233 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5234 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005235
5236 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5237 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5238 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5239 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5240 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5241 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5242 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5243 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005244 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005245 downsides of rare connection failures.
5246
5247 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5248 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5249 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5250 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5251 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5252 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005253 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005254 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5255 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5256 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5257 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5258 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5259
5260 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005261 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5262 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5263 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005264
5265 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005266 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005267
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005268 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5269 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005270
5271 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5272 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5273 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5274
5275 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5276 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5277 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5278
5279 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5280
5281
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005282http-send-name-header [<header>]
5283 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5285 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005286 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005287 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5288
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005289 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5290 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5291 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5292 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5293 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5294 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5295 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5296 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5297 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5298 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5299 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5300 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5301 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5302 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5303 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5304 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005305
5306 See also : "server"
5307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005308id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005309 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5311 no | yes | yes | yes
5312 Arguments : none
5313
5314 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5315 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5316 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005317
5318
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005319ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5320 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005322 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005323
5324 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5325 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5326 and running).
5327
5328 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5329 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5330 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005331 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005332 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005334 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5335 "unless" condition is met.
5336
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005337 Example:
5338 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5339 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5340 ignore-persist if url_static
5341
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005342 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5343
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005344load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5345 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | no | yes | yes
5348
5349 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5350 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5351 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005352 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005353 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5354 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5355 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5356 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5357
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005358 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005359 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005360 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005361
5362 Arguments:
5363 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5364 named "server-state-file".
5365
5366 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5367 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5368 name is used as a file name.
5369
5370 none don't load any stat for this backend
5371
5372 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005373 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5374 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5375 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005376 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005377 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005378
5379 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5380 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005382 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005383
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005384 global
5385 stats socket /tmp/socket
5386 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005387
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005388 defaults
5389 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005390
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005391 backend bk
5392 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5393 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005394
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005395
5396 Then one can run :
5397
5398 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5399
5400 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5401
5402 1
5403 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5404 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5405 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5406
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005407 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005408
5409 global
5410 stats socket /tmp/socket
5411 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5412
5413 defaults
5414 load-server-state-from-file local
5415
5416 backend bk
5417 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5418 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5419
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005420
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005421 Then one can run :
5422
5423 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5424
5425 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5426
5427 1
5428 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5429 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5430 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5431
5432 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5433 "show servers state"
5434
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005435
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005436log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005437log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5438 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005439no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005443
5444 Prefix :
5445 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5446 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5447 prefix does not allow arguments.
5448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005449 Arguments :
5450 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5451 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5452 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5453 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5454 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5455 parameter.
5456
5457 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5458 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5459
5460 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5461 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5462 standard syslog port).
5463
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005464 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5465 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5466 standard syslog port).
5467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005468 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5469 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5470 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005471 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005472
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005473 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5474 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5475 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5476 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5477 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5478 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5479 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5480 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5481 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5482 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5483 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5484 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5485 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5486 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5487 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5488 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005489 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5490 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005491
5492 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5493 and "fd@2", see above.
5494
5495 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5496 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005497
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005498 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5499 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5500 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5501 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5502 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5503 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5504 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5505 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5506 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5507 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005508 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005509
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005510 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5511 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5512 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5513 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5514 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5515
5516 <sample_size>
5517 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5518 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5519 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5520 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5521 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5522
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005523 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5524 one of the following :
5525
5526 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5527 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5528
5529 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5530 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5531
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005532 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5533 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5534 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5535 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5536 systemd logger consumes.
5537
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005538 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5539 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5540 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5541 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5542
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005543 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5544
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005545 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5546 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5547 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5548
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005549 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5550 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5551 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5552 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005553
5554 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5555 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5556 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005557 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5558 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5559 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5560 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5561 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005562
5563 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5564
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005565 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5566 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5567 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005568
5569 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5570 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5571 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5572 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5573
5574 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5575 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005576
5577 Example :
5578 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005579 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5580 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5581 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005582 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5583 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005584 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005585
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005587log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005588 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5589 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5590 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005591
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005592 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5593 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5594 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5595 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5596 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005597
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005598 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5599 "option httplog" directives.
5600
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005601log-format-sd <string>
5602 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5603 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | yes | yes | no
5605
5606 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5607 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5608 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5609 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5610 which covers the log format string in depth.
5611
5612 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5613 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5614
5615 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5616 log format to "rfc5424".
5617
5618 Example :
5619 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5620
5621
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005622log-tag <string>
5623 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5625 yes | yes | yes | yes
5626
5627 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5628 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5629 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5630 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5631 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5632 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5633 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5634 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5635 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005636
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005637max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5638 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5640 yes | no | yes | yes
5641
5642 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5643 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5644 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5645 servers.
5646
5647 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5648 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5649 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5650 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5651 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005652 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005653 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5654 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5655 picking a different server.
5656
5657 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5658 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5659 even if they have to be queued.
5660
5661 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5662 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5663
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005664max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5665 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5666 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5667 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005668
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005669maxconn <conns>
5670 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5672 yes | yes | yes | no
5673 Arguments :
5674 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5675 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5676 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5677 closes.
5678
5679 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5680 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5681 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5682 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005683 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5684 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5685 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5686 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687
5688 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5689 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5690 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5691
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005692 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5693 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005695 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5696
5697
5698mode { tcp|http|health }
5699 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5701 yes | yes | yes | yes
5702 Arguments :
5703 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5704 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5705 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5706 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5707
5708 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5709 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5710 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5711 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5712 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5713
5714 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005715 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5716 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5717 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5718 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5719 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5720 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5721 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005722
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005723 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5724 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5725 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005726
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005727 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728 defaults http_instances
5729 mode http
5730
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005731 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005733
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005734monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005738 Arguments :
5739 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5740 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005741 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005742 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5743 backend and its backup.
5744
5745 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5746 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5747 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5748 servers in a list of backends.
5749
5750 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5751 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5752 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5753 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5754 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5755 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5756 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005757 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5758 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005759
5760 Example:
5761 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005762 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005763 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5764 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5765 monitor-uri /site_alive
5766 monitor fail if site_dead
5767
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005768 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005769
5770
5771monitor-net <source>
5772 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5774 yes | yes | yes | no
5775 Arguments :
5776 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5777 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5778 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5779 followed by a mask.
5780
5781 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5782 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005783 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005784 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5785
5786 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5787 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5788 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5789 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005790 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5791 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5792 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005793
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005794 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5795 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5796 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5797 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5798 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5799 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005800
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005801 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5802 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005803
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005804 Example :
5805 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5806 frontend www
5807 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5808
5809 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5810
5811
5812monitor-uri <uri>
5813 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5815 yes | yes | yes | no
5816 Arguments :
5817 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5818 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5819
5820 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5821 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5822 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5823 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5824 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5825 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5826 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5827 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5828
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005829 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5830 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5831 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5832 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5833 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5834 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5835 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5836 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005837
5838 Example :
5839 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5840 frontend www
5841 mode http
5842 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5843
5844 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5845
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005847option abortonclose
5848no option abortonclose
5849 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | no | yes | yes
5852 Arguments : none
5853
5854 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5855 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5856 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5857 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005858 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005859 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5860 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5861 encountered while delivering the response.
5862
5863 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5864 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5865 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5866 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5867 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5868 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005869 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005870 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005871 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005872 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5873 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5874 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005876 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5877 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005878 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5879 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5880 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5881 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5882 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5883 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005884 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005885
5886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5888
5889 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5890
5891
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005892option accept-invalid-http-request
5893no option accept-invalid-http-request
5894 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | yes | yes | no
5897 Arguments : none
5898
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005899 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005900 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005901 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005902 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5903 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5904 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5905 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5906 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005907 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5908 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5909 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5910 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005911 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005912 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005913 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5914 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5915 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005916
5917 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5918 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5919 been confirmed.
5920
5921 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5922 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005923 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5924 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005925 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5926
5927 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5928 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5929
5930 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5931 stats socket.
5932
5933
5934option accept-invalid-http-response
5935no option accept-invalid-http-response
5936 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | no | yes | yes
5939 Arguments : none
5940
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005941 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005942 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005943 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005944 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5945 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5946 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5947 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5948 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005949 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5950 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5951 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005952
5953 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5954 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5955 been confirmed.
5956
5957 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5958 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5959 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5960 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5961
5962 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5963 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5964
5965 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5966 stats socket.
5967
5968
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005969option allbackups
5970no option allbackups
5971 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5973 yes | no | yes | yes
5974 Arguments : none
5975
5976 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5977 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5978 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5979 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5980 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5981 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5982 order between the backup servers anymore.
5983
5984 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5985 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5986
5987 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5988 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5989
5990
5991option checkcache
5992no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005993 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5995 yes | no | yes | yes
5996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5999 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006000 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006001 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6002 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006003 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006004
6005 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006006 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006007 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006008 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6009 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006010 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006011 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006012 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6013 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006014 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006015 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6016 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006017 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006018 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6019 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6020 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6021 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6022 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6023 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6024 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6025 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6026 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6027
6028 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006029 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006030 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006031 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006032 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6033
6034 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6035 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006036 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006037 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006038
6039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6041
6042
6043option clitcpka
6044no option clitcpka
6045 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6047 yes | yes | yes | no
6048 Arguments : none
6049
6050 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6051 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006052 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006053 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6054
6055 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6056 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6057 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6058 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6059
6060 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6061 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6062 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6063 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6064 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6065
6066 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6067
6068 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6069 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6070 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6071
6072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6074
6075 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6076
6077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006078option contstats
6079 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6081 yes | yes | yes | no
6082 Arguments : none
6083
6084 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6085 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6086 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6087 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006088 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6089 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6090 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6091 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6092 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006093
6094
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006095option dontlog-normal
6096no option dontlog-normal
6097 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6099 yes | yes | yes | no
6100 Arguments : none
6101
6102 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6103 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6104 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6105 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6106 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6107 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6108 logged.
6109
6110 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6111 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6112 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006114 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006115 logging.
6116
6117
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006118option dontlognull
6119no option dontlognull
6120 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6122 yes | yes | yes | no
6123 Arguments : none
6124
6125 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6126 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6127 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6128 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6129 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6130 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006131 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6132 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6133 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006134
6135 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006136 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006137 would not be logged.
6138
6139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6141
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006142 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6143 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006144
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006145
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006146option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006147 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6149 yes | yes | yes | yes
6150 Arguments :
6151 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6152 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006153 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006154 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006155
6156 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6157 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6158 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6159 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6160 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6161 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6162 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006163 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6164 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6165 possible that the client has already brought one.
6166
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006167 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006168 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006169 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006170 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006171 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006172 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006173
6174 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6175 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6176 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6177 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6178 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6179 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6180 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6181
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006182 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6183 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6184 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6185 are under the control of the end-user.
6186
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006187 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006188 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6189 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006190 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6191 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6192 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006193
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006194 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006195 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6196 frontend www
6197 mode http
6198 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6199
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006200 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6201 backend www
6202 mode http
6203 option forwardfor header X-Client
6204
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006205 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006206 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006207
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006208
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006209option http-buffer-request
6210no option http-buffer-request
6211 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | yes | yes | yes
6214 Arguments : none
6215
6216 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6217 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6218 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6219 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6220 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6221 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6222 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6223 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006224 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006225 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6226 default.
6227
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006228 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006229
6230
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006231option http-ignore-probes
6232no option http-ignore-probes
6233 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6235 yes | yes | yes | no
6236 Arguments : none
6237
6238 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6239 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6240 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6241 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6242 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6243 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6244 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6245 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6246 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006247 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6248 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006249 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6250
6251 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6252 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6253 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6254 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6255 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6256 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6257 are often the only way to detect them.
6258
6259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6261
6262 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6263
6264
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006265option http-keep-alive
6266no option http-keep-alive
6267 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | yes | yes | yes
6270 Arguments : none
6271
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006272 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6273 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006274 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6275 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6276 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6277 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6278 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006279
6280 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6281 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006282 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6283 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6284 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6285 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6286 situations where this option may be useful :
6287
6288 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006289 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006290
6291 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6292 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6293
6294 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6295 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6296 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6297 request.
6298
6299 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6300 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006301 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6302 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6303 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006304
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006305 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6306 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6307 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6308 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6309 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6310 not set.
6311
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006312 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006313 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6314 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006315
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006316 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006317 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006318 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006319
6320
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006321option http-no-delay
6322no option http-no-delay
6323 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | yes | yes | yes
6326 Arguments : none
6327
6328 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6329 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6330 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6331 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6332 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6333 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6334 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6335 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6336 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6337 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6338 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6339 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6340 affected.
6341
6342 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6343 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6344 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6345 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6346 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6347 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6348 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6349 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6350 latency environments.
6351
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006352 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6353
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006354
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006355option http-pretend-keepalive
6356no option http-pretend-keepalive
6357 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006359 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006360 Arguments : none
6361
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006362 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006363 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6364 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6365 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6366 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6367 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6368 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6369 consider the response complete.
6370
6371 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6372 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6373 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6374 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006375 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006376 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6377
6378 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6379 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6380 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6381 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6382 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6383 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6384 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6385
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006386 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6387 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6388 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6389 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6390 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6391 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006392
6393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6395
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006396 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006397 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006398
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006399
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006400option http-server-close
6401no option http-server-close
6402 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 yes | yes | yes | yes
6405 Arguments : none
6406
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006407 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6408 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6409 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6410 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006411 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6412 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6413 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6414 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6415 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6416 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6417 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6418 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6419 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6420 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6421 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006422
6423 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6424 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6425 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6426 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006427 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6428 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006429
6430 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6431 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006432 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6433 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6434 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006435
6436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6438
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006439 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6440 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006441
6442
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006443option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6444no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6445 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006447 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006448 Arguments : none
6449
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006450 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6451 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6452 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6453
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006454 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6455 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6456 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6457 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006458 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006459
6460 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006461 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006462 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6463 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6464 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6465 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6466 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6467 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6468 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006469
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006470 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6471 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6472 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6473 backend.
6474
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6477
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006478 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6479 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006480
6481
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006482option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006483no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006484 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | yes | yes | no
6487 Arguments : none
6488
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006489 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006490 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6491 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6492 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6493 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6494 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6495 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6496
6497 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6498 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006499 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6500 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6501 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006502
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006503 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6504 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6505 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6506 front of an existing proxy.
6507
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006508 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6509
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006510 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006511
6512
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006513option http-use-htx
6514no option http-use-htx
6515 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6517 yes | yes | yes | yes
6518 Arguments : none
6519
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006520 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006521 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006522 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6523 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6524 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6525 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6526 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006527
6528 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6529 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6530 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6531 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006532 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6533 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6534 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6535 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006536
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006537 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6538 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6539 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6540 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6541 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006542
6543 See also : "mode http"
6544
6545
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006546option httpchk
6547option httpchk <uri>
6548option httpchk <method> <uri>
6549option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6550 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 yes | no | yes | yes
6553 Arguments :
6554 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6555 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6556 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6557 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6558 ones.
6559
6560 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6561 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6562 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6563
6564 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6565 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6566 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6567 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6568 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6569
6570 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6571 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6572 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6573 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6574 the lack of any response.
6575
6576 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6577
6578 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6579 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6580 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6581
6582 Examples :
6583 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6584 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6585 backend https_relay
6586 mode tcp
6587 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6588 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6589
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006590 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6591 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6592 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006593
6594
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006595option httpclose
6596no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006597 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | yes | yes | yes
6600 Arguments : none
6601
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006602 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6603 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6604 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6605 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006606 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006607
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006608 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6609 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006610 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006611 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6612 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006613
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006614 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6615 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6616 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006617
6618 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6619 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006620 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006621 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6622 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6623 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006624
6625 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6626 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6627
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006628 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006629
6630
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006631option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006632 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006634 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006635 Arguments :
6636 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6637 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6638 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006639 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006640 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006641
6642 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6643 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6644 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6645 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6646 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6647 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6648 ports.
6649
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006650 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6651 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006652
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006653 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006655 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006657
6658option http_proxy
6659no option http_proxy
6660 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6662 yes | yes | yes | yes
6663 Arguments : none
6664
6665 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6666 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6667 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6668 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6669 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6670
6671 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6672 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006673 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6674 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006675
6676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6678
6679 Example :
6680 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6681 backend direct_forward
6682 option httpclose
6683 option http_proxy
6684
6685 See also : "option httpclose"
6686
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006687
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006688option independent-streams
6689no option independent-streams
6690 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | yes | yes | yes
6693 Arguments : none
6694
6695 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6696 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6697 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6698 receive data or not.
6699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006700 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006701 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6702 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6703 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6704 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6705 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6706 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6707 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6708 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6709 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6710 socket buffers.
6711
6712 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6713 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6714 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6715 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6716 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6717
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006718 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006719 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6720 deprecated.
6721
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006722 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006723
6724
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006725option ldap-check
6726 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6728 yes | no | yes | yes
6729 Arguments : none
6730
6731 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6732 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6733 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6734 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6735
6736 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6737 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6738
6739 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6740 configure it.
6741
6742 Example :
6743 option ldap-check
6744
6745 See also : "option httpchk"
6746
6747
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006748option external-check
6749 Use external processes for server health checks
6750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6751 yes | no | yes | yes
6752
6753 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6754 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6755 command".
6756
6757 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6758
6759 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6760
6761
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006762option log-health-checks
6763no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006764 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6766 yes | no | yes | yes
6767 Arguments : none
6768
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006769 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6770 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6771 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006772
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006773 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6774 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6775 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6776 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6777 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006779 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006780 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006781
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006782 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6783 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6784 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006785
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006786
6787option log-separate-errors
6788no option log-separate-errors
6789 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 yes | yes | yes | no
6792 Arguments : none
6793
6794 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6795 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6796 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6797 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6798 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6799 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6800 provides very important information.
6801
6802 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6803 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6804 error logs.
6805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006806 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006807 logging.
6808
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006809
6810option logasap
6811no option logasap
6812 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 yes | yes | yes | no
6815 Arguments : none
6816
6817 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6818 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6819 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6820 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6821 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6822 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6823 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006824 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006825 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6826 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006828 Examples :
6829 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6830 mode http
6831 option httplog
6832 option logasap
6833 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6834
6835 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6836 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6837 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6838 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006840 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006841 logging.
6842
6843
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006844option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006845 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006848 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006849 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6850 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006851 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006852
6853 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6854 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006855 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006856 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6857 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6858 in the MySQL table, like this :
6859
6860 USE mysql;
6861 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6862 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6863
6864 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006865 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006866 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6867 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6868 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6869 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6870 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6871 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6872 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6873
6874 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6875 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006876
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006877 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006878
6879 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6880 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6881 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6882 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006883 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6884 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006885
6886 See also: "option httpchk"
6887
6888
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006889option nolinger
6890no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006891 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006892 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006894 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006896 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006897 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6898 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6899 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6900 connections.
6901
6902 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6903 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6904 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6905 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6906 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6907 this too.
6908
6909 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6910 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6911 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6912
6913 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6914 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6915 for servers.
6916
6917 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6918 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6919
6920
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006921option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6922 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6924 yes | yes | yes | yes
6925 Arguments :
6926 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6927 matching <network>
6928 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6929 header name.
6930
6931 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6932 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6933 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6934 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6935 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6936 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6937 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6938 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6939 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6940 possible that the client has already brought one.
6941
6942 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6943 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6944 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6945 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6946 header and requires different one.
6947
6948 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6949 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6950 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6951 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6952 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6953 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6954 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6955
6956 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6957 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6958 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6959 both are defined.
6960
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006961 Examples :
6962 # Original Destination address
6963 frontend www
6964 mode http
6965 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6966
6967 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6968 backend www
6969 mode http
6970 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6971
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006972 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006973
6974
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006975option persist
6976no option persist
6977 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6979 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006980 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006981
6982 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6983 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6984 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6985 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6986 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6987 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6988 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6989 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6990 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6991 redirected to another valid server.
6992
6993 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6994 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6995
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006996 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006997
6998
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006999option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7000 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | no | yes | yes
7003 Arguments :
7004 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7005 PostgreSQL server.
7006
7007 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7008 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7009 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7010 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7011
7012 See also: "option httpchk"
7013
7014
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007015option prefer-last-server
7016no option prefer-last-server
7017 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 yes | no | yes | yes
7020 Arguments : none
7021
7022 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7023 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7024 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7025 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7026 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7027 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7028 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7029 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7030 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007031 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7032 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007033 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7034 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7035 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007036 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7037 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7038 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007039
7040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7042
7043 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7044
7045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007046option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007047option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007048no option redispatch
7049 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7050 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7051 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007052 Arguments :
7053 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7054 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7055 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007056 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007057 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007058 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007059 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7060 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7061 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007063
7064 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7065 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7066 be able to access the service anymore.
7067
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007068 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7069 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007070
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007071 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007072 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7073 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007075 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7076 "redisp" keywords.
7077
7078 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7079 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7080
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007081 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007082
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007083
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007084option redis-check
7085 Use redis health checks for server testing
7086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7087 yes | no | yes | yes
7088 Arguments : none
7089
7090 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7091 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7092 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7093 find the "+PONG" response message.
7094
7095 Example :
7096 option redis-check
7097
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007098 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007099
7100
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007101option smtpchk
7102option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7103 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7105 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007106 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007107 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007108 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007109 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7110
7111 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7112 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7113 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7114
7115 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7116 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7117 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7118 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7119 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7120 dead server.
7121
7122 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7123 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007124 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007125 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7126
7127 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7128 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7129 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7130 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007131 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007132
7133 Example :
7134 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7135
7136 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007138
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007139option socket-stats
7140no option socket-stats
7141
7142 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 yes | yes | yes | no
7145
7146 Arguments : none
7147
7148
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007149option splice-auto
7150no option splice-auto
7151 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 yes | yes | yes | yes
7154 Arguments : none
7155
7156 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7157 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007159 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007160 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007161 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7162 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7163 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7164 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7165
7166 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7167 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7168 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7169 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7170 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7171 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7172 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7173 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7174 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7175 keyword.
7176
7177 Example :
7178 option splice-auto
7179
7180 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7181 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7182
7183 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7184 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7185
7186
7187option splice-request
7188no option splice-request
7189 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7191 yes | yes | yes | yes
7192 Arguments : none
7193
7194 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007195 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007196 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7197 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7198 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7199 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7200
7201 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7202
7203 Example :
7204 option splice-request
7205
7206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7208
7209 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7210 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7211
7212
7213option splice-response
7214no option splice-response
7215 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7217 yes | yes | yes | yes
7218 Arguments : none
7219
7220 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007221 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007222 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7223 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7224 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7225 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7226
7227 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7228
7229 Example :
7230 option splice-response
7231
7232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7234
7235 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7236 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7237
7238
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007239option spop-check
7240 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7242 no | no | no | yes
7243 Arguments : none
7244
7245 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7246 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7247 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7248 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7249
7250 Example :
7251 option spop-check
7252
7253 See also : "option httpchk"
7254
7255
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007256option srvtcpka
7257no option srvtcpka
7258 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7260 yes | no | yes | yes
7261 Arguments : none
7262
7263 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7264 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007265 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007266 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7267
7268 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7269 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7270 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7271 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7272
7273 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7274 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7275 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7276 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7277 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7278
7279 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7280
7281 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7282 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7283 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7284
7285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7287
7288 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7289
7290
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007291option ssl-hello-chk
7292 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7294 yes | no | yes | yes
7295 Arguments : none
7296
7297 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7298 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7299 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7300 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7301 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7302 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7303 hello message.
7304
7305 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7306 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7307 messages, which is appreciable.
7308
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007309 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7310 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7311 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007312
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007313 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7314
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007315
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007316option tcp-check
7317 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7319 yes | no | yes | yes
7320
7321 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7322 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7323
7324 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7325 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7326 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7327
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007328 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007329 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7330 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7331 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7332 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7333 only.
7334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007335 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007336 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7337 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7338 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7339 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7340
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007341 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007342 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7343 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007344 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007345 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7346 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7347 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7348 the respective protocols.
7349 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007350 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007351
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007352 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7353 script.
7354
7355 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7356 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7357 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7358 The "comment" is of course optional.
7359
7360
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007361 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007362 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007363 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007364 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007366 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007367 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007368 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007369
7370 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7371 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007372 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007373 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007374 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007375 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007376 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007377 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007378 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7379 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007380 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007381 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7382 tcp-check expect string +OK
7383
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007384 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007385 (send many headers before analyzing)
7386 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007387 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007388 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7389 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7390 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7391 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007392 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007393
7394
7395 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7396
7397
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007398option tcp-smart-accept
7399no option tcp-smart-accept
7400 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 yes | yes | yes | no
7403 Arguments : none
7404
7405 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7406 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7407 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7408 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7409 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7410 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7411
7412 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7413 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7414 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7415 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7416
7417 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7418 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7419 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007420 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007421
7422 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7423 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7424 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7425
7426 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7427 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7428 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7429
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007430 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7431
7432
7433option tcp-smart-connect
7434no option tcp-smart-connect
7435 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7437 yes | no | yes | yes
7438 Arguments : none
7439
7440 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7441 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7442 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7443 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7444 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7445
7446 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7447 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7448 complex.
7449
7450 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7451 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7452 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7453
7454 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7455 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7456
7457 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7458
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007459
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007460option tcpka
7461 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 yes | yes | yes | yes
7464 Arguments : none
7465
7466 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7467 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007468 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007469 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7470
7471 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7472 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7473 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7474 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7475
7476 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7477 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7478 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7479 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7480 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7481
7482 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7483
7484 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7485 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7486 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7487 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7488 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7489 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7490 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7491 backends.
7492
7493 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7494
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007495
7496option tcplog
7497 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007499 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007500 Arguments : none
7501
7502 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7503 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7504 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7505 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7506 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7507 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7508 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7509 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7510
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007511 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007513 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007514
7515
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007516option transparent
7517no option transparent
7518 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007520 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007521 Arguments : none
7522
7523 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7524 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7525 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7526 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7527 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7528 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7529 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7530 appropriate server.
7531
7532 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7533 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7534
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007535 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007536 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007537
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007538
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007539external-check command <command>
7540 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7542 yes | no | yes | yes
7543
7544 Arguments :
7545 <command> is the external command to run
7546
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007547 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7548
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007549 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007550
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007551 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7552 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7553 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7554 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7555 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7556 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007557
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007558 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7559
7560 Environment variables :
7561 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7562 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7563
7564 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7565
7566 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7567
7568 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7569 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7570 for a UNIX socket).
7571
7572 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7573
7574 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7575
7576 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7577
7578 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7579
7580 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7581
7582 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7583 socket).
7584
7585 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7586 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7587
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007588 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7589
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007590 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7591 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7592 failed.
7593
7594 Example :
7595 external-check command /bin/true
7596
7597 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7598
7599
7600external-check path <path>
7601 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7603 yes | no | yes | yes
7604
7605 Arguments :
7606 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7607
7608 The default path is "".
7609
7610 Example :
7611 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7612
7613 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7614 "external-check command"
7615
7616
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007617persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007618persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007619 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | no | yes | yes
7622 Arguments :
7623 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007624 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7625 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007626
7627 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7628 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007629 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007630 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7631 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7632 forwarded to this server.
7633
7634 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7635 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7636 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007637 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007638 a single "listen" section.
7639
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007640 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7641 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7642 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7643
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007644 Example :
7645 listen tse-farm
7646 bind :3389
7647 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7648 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7649 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7650 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7651 persist rdp-cookie
7652 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007653 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007654 balance rdp-cookie
7655 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7656 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7657
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007658 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7659 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007660
7661
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007662rate-limit sessions <rate>
7663 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | yes | yes | no
7666 Arguments :
7667 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7668 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7669
7670 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7671 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7672 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7673 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7674 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7675 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7676
7677 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7678 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7679 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7680 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7681
7682 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7683 listen smtp
7684 mode tcp
7685 bind :25
7686 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007687 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007688
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007689 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7690 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7691 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007692
7693 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7694
7695
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007696redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7697redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7698redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007699 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 no | yes | yes | yes
7702
7703 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007704 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007705
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007706 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007707 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007708 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7709 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7710 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007711
7712 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7713 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7714 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7715 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7716 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007717 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7718 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7719 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7720 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007721
7722 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7723 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7724 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7725 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7726 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7727 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007728 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007729 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007730 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7731 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7732 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007733
7734 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007735 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7736 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7737 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007738 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007739 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7740 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7741 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7742 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007743
7744 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007745 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007746
7747 - "drop-query"
7748 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7749 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7750 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7751 with a location-type redirect.
7752
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007753 - "append-slash"
7754 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7755 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7756 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7757 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7758
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007759 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7760 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7761 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7762 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7763 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7764 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7765 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7766
7767 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7768 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7769 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7770 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7771 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7772 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7773 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007774
7775 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7776 acl clear dst_port 80
7777 acl secure dst_port 8080
7778 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007779 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007780 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007781 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7782
7783 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007784 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7785 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7786 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007787 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007788
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007789 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7790 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7791 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7792
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007793 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007794 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007795
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007796 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007797 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7798 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7799 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007801 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007802
7803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007804redisp (deprecated)
7805redispatch (deprecated)
7806 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7808 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007809 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007810
7811 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7812 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7813 be able to access the service anymore.
7814
7815 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7816 redistribute them to a working server.
7817
7818 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7819 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7820 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007822 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7823 "option redispatch" instead.
7824
7825 See also : "option redispatch"
7826
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007827
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007828reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007829 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7831 no | yes | yes | yes
7832 Arguments :
7833 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7834 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007835 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007836
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007837 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7838 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7839
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007840 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7841 the last header of an HTTP request.
7842
7843 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7844 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7845 responses.
7846
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007847 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7848 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7849 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7850
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007851 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7852 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007853
7854
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007855reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7856reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007857 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 no | yes | yes | yes
7860 Arguments :
7861 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7862 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7863 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7864 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7865 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7866 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7867 ignores case.
7868
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007869 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7870 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7871
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007872 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7873 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7874 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7875 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007876 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877
7878 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7879 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7880
7881 Example :
7882 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7883 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7884 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7885
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007886 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7887 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007888
7889
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007890reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7891reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007892 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 no | yes | yes | yes
7895 Arguments :
7896 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7897 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7898 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7899 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7900 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7901 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7902
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007903 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7904 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7905
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007906 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7907 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7908 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7909 next servers.
7910
7911 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7912 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7913 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7914
7915 Example :
7916 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7917 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7918 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7919
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007920 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7921 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007922
7923
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007924reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7925reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007926 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 no | yes | yes | yes
7929 Arguments :
7930 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7931 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7932 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7933 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7934 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7935 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7936 case.
7937
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007938 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7939 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7940
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007941 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7942 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7943 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7944 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007945 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007946
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007947 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007948 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007949 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007950
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007951 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7952 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7953
7954 Example :
7955 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7956 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7957 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7958
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007959 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7960 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007961
7962
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007963reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7964reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007965 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 no | yes | yes | yes
7968 Arguments :
7969 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7970 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7971 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7972 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7973 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7974 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7975 case.
7976
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007977 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7978 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7979
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007980 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7981 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7982 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7983 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7984
7985 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7986 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7987
7988 Example :
7989 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7990 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7991 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7992 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7993
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007994 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7995 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007996
7997
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007998reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7999reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008000 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 no | yes | yes | yes
8003 Arguments :
8004 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8005 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8006 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8007 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8008 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8009 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8010
8011 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8012 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8013 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8014 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008015 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008016
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008017 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8018 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8019
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008020 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8021 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8022 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8023
8024 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8025 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8026 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8027 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8028 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8029
8030 Example :
8031 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008032 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008033 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8034 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8035
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008036 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8037 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008038
8039
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008040reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8041reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008042 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8044 no | yes | yes | yes
8045 Arguments :
8046 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8047 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8048 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8049 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8050 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8051 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8052 ignores case.
8053
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008054 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8055 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8056
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008057 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8058 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008059 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8060 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8061 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008062 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8063 not set.
8064
8065 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8066 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8067 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8068 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8069 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008071 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008072 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008073 # block all others.
8074 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8075 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8076
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008077 # block bad guys
8078 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8079 reqitarpit . if badguys
8080
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008081 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8082 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008083
8084
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008085retries <value>
8086 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8087 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8088 yes | no | yes | yes
8089 Arguments :
8090 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8091 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8092 default value is 3.
8093
8094 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8095 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8096 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8097
8098 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008099 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8100 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008101
8102 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8103 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8104
8105 See also : "option redispatch"
8106
8107
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008108retry-on [list of keywords]
8109 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8110 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8111 yes | no | yes | yes
8112 Arguments :
8113 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8114 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8115 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8116 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8117
8118 none never retry
8119
8120 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8121 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8122
8123 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8124 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8125 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8126 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8127 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8128 processing the request.
8129
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008130 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8131 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8132 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8133 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8134 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8135 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8136 overflow attack for example).
8137
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008138 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8139 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8140 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8141 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8142 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8143 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8144 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8145 amplify denial of service attacks.
8146
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008147 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8148 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8149 considered to be safe to retry.
8150
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008151 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8152 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8153 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8154 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8155
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008156 all-retryable-errors
8157 retry request for any error that are considered
8158 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8159 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8160 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8161
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008162 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8163 not cumulative.
8164
8165 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8166 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8167 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8168 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8169
8170 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8171 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8172 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8173 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8174 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8175 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8176 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8177 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8178 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8179 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8180 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8181 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8182
8183 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8184 should not use this directive.
8185
8186 The default is "conn-failure".
8187
8188 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8189
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008190rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008191 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8193 no | yes | yes | yes
8194 Arguments :
8195 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8196 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008197 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008198
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008199 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8200 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8201
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008202 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8203 the last header of an HTTP response.
8204
8205 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8206 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8207 responses.
8208
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008209 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8210 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008211
8212
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008213rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8214rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008215 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 no | yes | yes | yes
8218 Arguments :
8219 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8220 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8221 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8222 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8223 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8224 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8225 ignores case.
8226
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008227 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8228 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8229
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008230 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8231 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008232 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008233 client.
8234
8235 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8236 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8237 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8238
8239 Example :
8240 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008241 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008242
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008243 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8244 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008245
8246
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008247rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8248rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008249 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8251 no | yes | yes | yes
8252 Arguments :
8253 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8254 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8255 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8256 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8257 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8258 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8259 ignores case.
8260
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008261 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8262 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8263
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008264 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8265 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8266 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8267 case-sensitive.
8268
8269 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008270 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8271 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8272 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008273
8274 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8275 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8276
8277 Example :
8278 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8279 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8280
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008281 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8282 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008283
8284
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008285rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8286rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008287 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8289 no | yes | yes | yes
8290 Arguments :
8291 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8292 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8293 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8294 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8295 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8296 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8297 ignores case.
8298
8299 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8300 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8301 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8302 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008303 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008304
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008305 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8306 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8307
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008308 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8309 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8310 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8311
8312 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8313 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8314 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8315 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8316 are not case-sensitive.
8317
8318 Example :
8319 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8320 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8321
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008322 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8323 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008324
8325
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008326server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327 Declare a server in a backend
8328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8329 no | no | yes | yes
8330 Arguments :
8331 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008332 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008333 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008334
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008335 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8336 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8337 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8338 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008339 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8340 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8341 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8342 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8343 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008344 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8345 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8346 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8347 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8348 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8349 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8350 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008351 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008352 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8353 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8354 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8355 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8356 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8357 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8359 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008360 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8361 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008363 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008364 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8365 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8366 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8367 adding this value to the client's port.
8368
8369 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8370 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008371 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008372
8373 Examples :
8374 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8375 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008376 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008377 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8378 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8379 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008381 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8382 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8383 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8384 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8385 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8386
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008387 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8388 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008389
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008390server-state-file-name [<file>]
8391 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8392 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8393 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8394 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8395 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8396 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8397
8398 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8399 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8400
8401 global
8402 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8403
8404 backend bk
8405 load-server-state-from-file
8406
8407 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8408 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008409
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008410server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8411 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8412 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 no | no | yes | yes
8415
8416 Arguments:
8417 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8418
8419 <num | range>
8420 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8421 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8422 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8423 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8424
8425 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8426
8427 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8428
8429 <params*>
8430 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8431 keyword.
8432
8433 Examples:
8434 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8435 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8436 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8437
8438 # or
8439 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8440
8441 # would be equivalent to:
8442 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8443 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8444 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8445
8446
8447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008448source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008449source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008450source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008451 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8453 yes | no | yes | yes
8454 Arguments :
8455 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8456 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008457
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008458 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008459 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8460 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8461 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8462 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8463 supported prefixes are :
8464 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8465 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8466 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008467 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8469 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008470
8471 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8472 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008473 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8474 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8475 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008476
8477 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8478 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8479 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8480 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8481 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8482 <addr>.
8483
8484 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8485 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8486 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8487 port.
8488
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008489 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8490 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8491 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8492 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008493 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008494 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8495 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8496 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8497 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8498 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8499 HTTP header.
8500
8501 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8502 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008503 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008504 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8505 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8506 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8507 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8508 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8509 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8510 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8511
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008512 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8513 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8514 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8515 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8516 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8517 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8518
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008519 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8520 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8521 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8522 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8523
8524 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8525 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8526 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8527 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8528 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8529 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8530
8531 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8532 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8533 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8534 there are two methods :
8535
8536 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8537 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8538 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8539 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8540 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8541 of the client ranges may be used.
8542
8543 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8544 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8545 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8546 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8547 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8548 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8549 same session.
8550
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008551 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8552 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8553 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008554 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008555
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008556 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8557
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008558 Examples :
8559 backend private
8560 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8561 source 192.168.1.200
8562
8563 backend transparent_ssl1
8564 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8565 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8566
8567 backend transparent_ssl2
8568 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8569 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8570 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8571
8572 backend transparent_ssl3
8573 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8574 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8575 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8576
8577 backend transparent_smtp
8578 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8579 # with Tproxy version 4.
8580 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8581
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008582 backend transparent_http
8583 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8584 # proxy.
8585 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008587 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008588 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008590
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008591srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8592 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8594 yes | no | yes | yes
8595 Arguments :
8596 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8597 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8598 as explained at the top of this document.
8599
8600 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8601 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8602 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8603 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8604 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8605 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8606 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8607
8608 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8609 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8610 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8611 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8612 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008613 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008614 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008615 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008616
8617 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8618 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8619 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8620 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8621 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8622 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8623
8624 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8625 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8626
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008627 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8628 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008629
8630
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008631stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8632 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008634 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008635
8636 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8637 matched.
8638
8639 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8640 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8641
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008642 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8643 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008644 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008645
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008646 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8647 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8648 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8649 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008650
8651 Example :
8652 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8653 backend stats_localhost
8654 stats enable
8655 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8656
8657 Example :
8658 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8659 backend stats_auth
8660 stats enable
8661 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8662 stats admin if TRUE
8663
8664 Example :
8665 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8666 userlist stats-auth
8667 group admin users admin
8668 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8669 group readonly users haproxy
8670 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8671
8672 backend stats_auth
8673 stats enable
8674 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8675 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8676 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8677 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8678
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008679 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8680 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8681 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008682
8683
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008684stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8685 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008687 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008688 Arguments :
8689 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8690
8691 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8692
8693 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8694 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8695 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8696 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8697 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8698 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8699
8700 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8701 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8702 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008703 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008704
8705 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8706 report using "stats scope".
8707
8708 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8709 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8710 unobvious parameters.
8711
8712 Example :
8713 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8714 backend public_www
8715 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8716 stats enable
8717 stats hide-version
8718 stats scope .
8719 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008720 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008721 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8722 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8723
8724 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8725 backend private_monitoring
8726 stats enable
8727 stats uri /admin?stats
8728 stats refresh 5s
8729
8730 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8731
8732
8733stats enable
8734 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008736 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008737 Arguments : none
8738
8739 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8740 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8741 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8742 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8743 - stats auth : no authentication
8744 - stats scope : no restriction
8745
8746 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8747 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8748 unobvious parameters.
8749
8750 Example :
8751 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8752 backend public_www
8753 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8754 stats enable
8755 stats hide-version
8756 stats scope .
8757 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008758 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008759 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8760 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8761
8762 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8763 backend private_monitoring
8764 stats enable
8765 stats uri /admin?stats
8766 stats refresh 5s
8767
8768 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8769
8770
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008771stats hide-version
8772 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008775 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008776
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8778 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8779 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8780 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8781 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8782 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008784 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8785 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8786 unobvious parameters.
8787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008788 Example :
8789 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8790 backend public_www
8791 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008792 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008793 stats hide-version
8794 stats scope .
8795 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008797 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8798 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008799
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008800 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8801 backend private_monitoring
8802 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008803 stats uri /admin?stats
8804 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008805
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008806 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008807
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008808
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008809stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8811 Access control for statistics
8812
8813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8814 no | no | yes | yes
8815
8816 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8817 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8818 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8819 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8820 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8821 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8822
8823 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8824 instance.
8825
8826 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8827 about ACL usage.
8828
8829
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008830stats realm <realm>
8831 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008833 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008834 Arguments :
8835 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8836 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8837 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8838
8839 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8840 using a backslash ('\').
8841
8842 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8843 only related to authentication.
8844
8845 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8846 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8847 unobvious parameters.
8848
8849 Example :
8850 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8851 backend public_www
8852 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8853 stats enable
8854 stats hide-version
8855 stats scope .
8856 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008857 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008858 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8859 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8860
8861 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8862 backend private_monitoring
8863 stats enable
8864 stats uri /admin?stats
8865 stats refresh 5s
8866
8867 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8868
8869
8870stats refresh <delay>
8871 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008873 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008874 Arguments :
8875 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8876 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8877 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8878 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8879 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8880 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8881
8882 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8883 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8884 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8885 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8886
8887 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8888 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8889 unobvious parameters.
8890
8891 Example :
8892 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8893 backend public_www
8894 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8895 stats enable
8896 stats hide-version
8897 stats scope .
8898 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008899 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008900 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8901 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8902
8903 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8904 backend private_monitoring
8905 stats enable
8906 stats uri /admin?stats
8907 stats refresh 5s
8908
8909 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8910
8911
8912stats scope { <name> | "." }
8913 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008916 Arguments :
8917 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8918 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8919 section in which the statement appears.
8920
8921 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8922 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8923 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8924 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8925 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8926 exists.
8927
8928 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8929 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8930 unobvious parameters.
8931
8932 Example :
8933 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8934 backend public_www
8935 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8936 stats enable
8937 stats hide-version
8938 stats scope .
8939 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008940 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008941 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8942 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8943
8944 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8945 backend private_monitoring
8946 stats enable
8947 stats uri /admin?stats
8948 stats refresh 5s
8949
8950 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8951
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008952
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008953stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008954 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008956 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008957
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008958 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008959 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8960
8961 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8962 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8963
8964 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8965 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008966 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967
8968 Example :
8969 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8970 backend private_monitoring
8971 stats enable
8972 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8973 stats uri /admin?stats
8974 stats refresh 5s
8975
8976 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8977 global section.
8978
8979
8980stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008981 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | yes | yes | yes
8984 Arguments : none
8985
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008986 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008987 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8988 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8989 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8990 - IP (socket, server)
8991 - cookie (backend, server)
8992
8993 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8994 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008995 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996
8997 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8998
8999
9000stats show-node [ <name> ]
9001 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009004 Arguments:
9005 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9006 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9007
9008 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9009 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009010 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009011
9012 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9013 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9014 unobvious parameters.
9015
9016 Example:
9017 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9018 backend private_monitoring
9019 stats enable
9020 stats show-node Europe-1
9021 stats uri /admin?stats
9022 stats refresh 5s
9023
9024 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9025 section.
9026
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009027
9028stats uri <prefix>
9029 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009031 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009032 Arguments :
9033 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9034 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9035 query string.
9036
9037 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9038 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9039 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9040 possible to reach it in the application.
9041
9042 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009043 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009044 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9045 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9046 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9047 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9048
9049 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9050 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9051 an address or a port to statistics only.
9052
9053 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9054 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9055 unobvious parameters.
9056
9057 Example :
9058 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9059 backend public_www
9060 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9061 stats enable
9062 stats hide-version
9063 stats scope .
9064 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009066 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9067 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9068
9069 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9070 backend private_monitoring
9071 stats enable
9072 stats uri /admin?stats
9073 stats refresh 5s
9074
9075 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9076
9077
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009078stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9079 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009081 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009082
9083 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009084 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009085 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009086 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009087 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9088
9089 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9090 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9091 the "stick-table" statement.
9092
9093 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9094 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9095 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9096 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9097 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9098
9099 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9100 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9101 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9102 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9103 transformation rules.
9104
9105 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9106 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9107 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9108 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9109 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9110 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9111 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9112
9113 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9114 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9115 ACL based conditions.
9116
9117 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9118 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9119 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9120 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9121
9122 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9123 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9124 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9125 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9126
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009127 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9128 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009129 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009130
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009131 Example :
9132 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9133 # last 30 minutes
9134 backend pop
9135 mode tcp
9136 balance roundrobin
9137 stick store-request src
9138 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9139 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9140 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9141
9142 backend smtp
9143 mode tcp
9144 balance roundrobin
9145 stick match src table pop
9146 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9147 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9148
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009149 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009150 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009151
9152
9153stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9154 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9156 no | no | yes | yes
9157
9158 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9159 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9160 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9161 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9162
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009163 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9164 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009165 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009166
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009167 Examples :
9168 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009169 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009170
9171 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9172 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9173 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9174
9175
9176 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9177 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9178 backend http
9179 mode http
9180 balance roundrobin
9181 stick on src table https
9182 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9183 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9184 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9185
9186 backend https
9187 mode tcp
9188 balance roundrobin
9189 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9190 stick on src
9191 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9192 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9193
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009194 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009195
9196
9197stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9198 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9200 no | no | yes | yes
9201
9202 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009203 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009204 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009205 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009206 server is selected.
9207
9208 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9209 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9210 the "stick-table" statement.
9211
9212 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9213 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9214 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9215 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9216 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9217 address.
9218
9219 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9220 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9221 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9222 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9223 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9224 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9225 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9226 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9227 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9228 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9229
9230 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9231 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9232 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9233 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9234 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9235 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9236 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9237
9238 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9239 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9240 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9241 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9242
9243 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9244 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9245 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9246 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9247 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9248 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009249 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9250 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9251 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9252 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9253 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9254 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009255
9256 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9257 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9258 the request.
9259
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009260 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9261 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009262 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009263
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009264 Example :
9265 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9266 # last 30 minutes
9267 backend pop
9268 mode tcp
9269 balance roundrobin
9270 stick store-request src
9271 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9272 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9273 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9274
9275 backend smtp
9276 mode tcp
9277 balance roundrobin
9278 stick match src table pop
9279 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9280 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9281
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009282 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009283 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009284
9285
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009286stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009287 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9288 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009289 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009291 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009292
9293 Arguments :
9294 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9295 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9296 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9297 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9298
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009299 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9300 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9301 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9302 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9303
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009304 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9305 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9306 instance.
9307
9308 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9309 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9310 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9311 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9312 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9313 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009314 to 32 characters.
9315
9316 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9317 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9318 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009319 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009320 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9321 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009322
9323 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009324 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9325 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009326 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9327 increase.
9328
9329 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009330 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9331 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9332 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009333
9334 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9335 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9336 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9337 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009338 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009339 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9340 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9341 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9342 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9343 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9344 parameter (see below).
9345
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009346 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9347 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9348 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9349 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9350 soft restart.
9351
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009352 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9353 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009354
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009355 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9356 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9357 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9358 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009359 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009360 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009361 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9362 if not expiration delay is specified.
9363
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009364 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9365 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9366 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9367 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009368 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9369 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9370 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9371 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9372 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9373 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9374 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9375 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9376 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9377 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9378 types and their arguments.
9379
9380 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9381 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9382 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9383 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9384
9385 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9386 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9387 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009388 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009389
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009390 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9391 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9392 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009394 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009396
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009397 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9398 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9399 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9400 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9401
9402 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9403 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9404 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9405 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9406 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9407 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9408
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009409 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9410 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9411 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9412 they were received.
9413
9414 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9415 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9416 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9417 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9418 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9419
9420 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9421 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9422 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9423 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9424 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9425
9426 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9427 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9428 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9429
9430 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9431 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9432 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9433 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9434 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9435
9436 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9437 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9438 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9439 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9440 the client side.
9441
9442 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9443 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9444 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9445 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9446 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9447 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9448 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9449
9450 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9451 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9452 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9453 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9454 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9455 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009456 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009457
9458 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9459 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9460 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9461 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9462 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9463 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9464
9465 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009466 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009467 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9468 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9469
9470 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9473 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9474 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9475 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9476 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9477 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9478 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9479 recommended for better fairness.
9480
9481 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009482 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009483 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9484 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9485
9486 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9487 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9489 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9490 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9491 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9492 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9493 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9494 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9495 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009496
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009497 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9498 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009499 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9500 reference it.
9501
9502 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9503 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009504 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9505 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9506 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009507
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009508 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9509 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9510 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9511 something that can be ignored.
9512
9513 Example:
9514 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9515 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9516 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9517 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9518
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009519 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009520 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009521
9522
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009523stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009524 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9526 no | no | yes | yes
9527
9528 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009529 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009530 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009531 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009532 server is selected.
9533
9534 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9535 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9536 the "stick-table" statement.
9537
9538 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9539 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9540 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9541 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9542
9543 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9544 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9545 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9546 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9547 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9548 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009549 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009550 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9551 rules.
9552
9553 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9554 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9555 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9556 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9557 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9558 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9559 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9560
9561 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9562 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9563 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9564 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9565
9566 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9567 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9568 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9569 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9570 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9571 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009572 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9573 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9574 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9575 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9576 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9577 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9578 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9579 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9580 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009581
9582 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9583
9584 Example :
9585 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9586 backend https
9587 mode tcp
9588 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009589 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009590 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009591
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009592 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9593 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9594
9595 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9596 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9597 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9598
9599 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9600 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009601
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009602 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9603 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9604 # at offset 44.
9605
9606 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9607 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9608
9609 # Learn on response if server hello.
9610 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009611
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009612 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9613 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9614
9615 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9616 extraction.
9617
9618
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009619tcp-check connect [params*]
9620 Opens a new connection
9621 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9622 no | no | yes | yes
9623
9624 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9625 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9626 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9627
9628 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9629 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9630 of the sequence.
9631
9632 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9633 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9634 do.
9635
9636 Parameters :
9637 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9638 use the TCP connection.
9639
9640 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9641 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9642 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9643
9644 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9645
9646 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9647
9648 Examples:
9649 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9650 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9651 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9652 option tcp-check
9653 tcp-check connect
9654 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9655 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9656 tcp-check send \r\n
9657 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9658 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9659 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9660 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9661 tcp-check send \r\n
9662 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9663 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9664
9665 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9666 option tcp-check
9667 tcp-check connect port 110
9668 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9669 tcp-check connect port 143
9670 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9671 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9672
9673 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9674
9675
9676tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9679 no | no | yes | yes
9680
9681 Arguments :
9682 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9683 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9684 binary.
9685 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9686 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9687 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9688
9689 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9690 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9691 with the usual backslash ('\').
9692 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009693 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009694 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9695 used upper or lower case.
9696
9697
9698 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9699
9700 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9701 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9702 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9703 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9704 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9705 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9706 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9707 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9708
9709 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9710 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9711 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9712 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9713 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9714 expression.
9715
9716 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9717 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9718 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9719 this exact hexadecimal string.
9720 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9721
9722 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9723 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9724 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9725 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9726 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9727 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9728 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9729 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9730 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9731 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9732 the null character.
9733
9734 Examples :
9735 # perform a POP check
9736 option tcp-check
9737 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9738
9739 # perform an IMAP check
9740 option tcp-check
9741 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9742
9743 # look for the redis master server
9744 option tcp-check
9745 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009746 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009747 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9748 tcp-check expect string role:master
9749 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9750 tcp-check expect string +OK
9751
9752
9753 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9754 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9755
9756
9757tcp-check send <data>
9758 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9760 no | no | yes | yes
9761
9762 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9763 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9764
9765 Examples :
9766 # look for the redis master server
9767 option tcp-check
9768 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9769 tcp-check expect string role:master
9770
9771 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9772 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9773
9774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009775tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9776 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009777 tcp health check
9778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9779 no | no | yes | yes
9780
9781 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9782 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009783 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009784 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9785 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9786 hexadecimal string.
9787 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9788
9789 Examples :
9790 # redis check in binary
9791 option tcp-check
9792 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9793 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9794
9795
9796 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9797 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9798
9799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9801 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9803 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009805 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9806 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009807
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009808 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009809
9810 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9811 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009812 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9813 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9814 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9815 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9816 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9817 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009819 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9820 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9821 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9822 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009823
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009824 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009825 - accept :
9826 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9827 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9828 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009829
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009830 - reject :
9831 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9832 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9833 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9834 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9835 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9836 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9837 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9838 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9839 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9840 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9841 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009842 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009843
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009844 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9845 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9846 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9847 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9848 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9849 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9850 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9851 hosts.
9852
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009853 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9854 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9855 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9856 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9857 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9858 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9859 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9860 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9861
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009862 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9863 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9864 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9865 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9866 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9867 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9868 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9869 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9870 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009871 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9872 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009873
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009874 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009875 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009876 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9877 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9878 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009879 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009880 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9881 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9882 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9883 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9884 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9885 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9886 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9887 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009890 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009891 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009892 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009893 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9894 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9895 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009896
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009897 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9898 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9899 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9900 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009902 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9903 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9904 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9905 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9906 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009907 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9908 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9909 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9910 layer7 information is extracted.
9911
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9913 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9914 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9915 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9916 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009917
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009918 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9919 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9920 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9921 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9922
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009923 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9924 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9925 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9926 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9927
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009928 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9929 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9930 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9931 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9932 continues.
9933
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009934 - set-src <expr> :
9935 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9936 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9937 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009938 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009940 Arguments:
9941 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9942 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009943
9944 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009945 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9946
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009947 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9948 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009949
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009950 - set-src-port <expr> :
9951 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9952 expression.
9953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009954 Arguments:
9955 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9956 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009957
9958 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009959 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9960
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009961 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9962 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9963 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009964
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009965 - set-dst <expr> :
9966 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9967 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9968 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9969 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9970 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9971
9972 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9973 followed by some converters.
9974
9975 Example:
9976
9977 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9978 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9979
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009980 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9981 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9982
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009983 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9984 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9985 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9986 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9987
9988
9989 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9990 followed by some converters.
9991
9992 Example:
9993
9994 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9995
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009996 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9997 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9998 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9999
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010000 - "silent-drop" :
10001 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010002 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010003 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10004 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10005 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10006 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10007 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010008 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10009 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010010 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10011 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010012 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010013 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10014 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10015 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10016 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010018 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10019 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10020 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010022 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10023 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10024 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010026 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010027 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010028 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010030 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10031 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10032 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010034 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010035 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10036 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010037
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010038 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10039
10040 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10041
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010042 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10043
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010044 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010045
10046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010047tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10048 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010050 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010052 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10053 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010054
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010055 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010056
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010057 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010058 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10059 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10060 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10061 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010063 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10064 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10065 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10066 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010067 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10068 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10069 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10070 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10071 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10072 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010073 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010074 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010076 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10077 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10078 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10079 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010080
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010081 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010082 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010083 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010084 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10085 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010086 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010087 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010088 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010089 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010090 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010091 - set-dst <expr>
10092 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010093 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010094 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010095 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010096 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010098 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10099 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010100 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10101 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010102
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010103 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10104 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10105 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10106 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10107 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10108 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010110 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010111 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10112 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010114 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010115 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10116 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10117 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10118 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010119 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10120 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10121 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010122
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010123 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010124 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10125 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10126 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010127
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010128 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10129 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10130
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010131 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010132 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10133 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010134
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010135 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10136 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010137 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010138 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10139 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010140 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010141 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010142 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010143 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10144 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010145 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010146 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10147 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010148
10149 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10150 followed by some converters.
10151
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010152 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10153 <var-name>.
10154
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010155 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10156 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10157 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10158 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10159 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10160
10161 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10162 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10163 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10164 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10165 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10166 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10167 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10168 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10169 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10170 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10171 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10172
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010173 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10174 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10175 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10176 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10177 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10178
10179 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10180
10181 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10182
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010183 Example:
10184
10185 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010186 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010187
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010188 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010189 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10190 # and reject everything else.
10191 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10192 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010193 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010194 tcp-request content reject
10195
10196 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010197 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10198 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10199 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010200 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010201
10202 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10203 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10204 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010205 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010206 tcp-request content reject
10207
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010208 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010209 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010210 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010211 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010212 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10213 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010214
10215 Example:
10216 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10217 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010218 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010221 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010222
10223 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010224 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010225 # protecting all our sites
10226 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010227 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10228 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010229 ...
10230 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10231
10232 backend http_dynamic
10233 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010234 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010235 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010236 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010237 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010238 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010239 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010241 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010242
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010243 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10244 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010245
10246
10247tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10248 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010250 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010251 Arguments :
10252 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10253 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10254 as explained at the top of this document.
10255
10256 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10257 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10258 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10259 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10260 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10261
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010262 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10263 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10264 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10265 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10266
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010267 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10268 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010269 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010270 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010271 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10272 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10273 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10274 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010275
10276 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10277 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10278 it pass through unaffected.
10279
10280 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10281 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10282 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010283 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010284 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10285 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010286 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10287 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10288 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010289
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010290 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010291 "timeout client".
10292
10293
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010294tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10295 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 no | no | yes | yes
10298 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010299 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10300 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010301
10302 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10303
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010304 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010305 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10306 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010307 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10308 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010309
10310 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10311
10312 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10313 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10314 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10315 inserted.
10316
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010317 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010318 - accept :
10319 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10320 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10321 the rules evaluation.
10322
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010323 - close :
10324 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10325 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10326 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10327 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10328 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10329 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010330 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010331 protocols.
10332
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010333 - reject :
10334 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10335 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010336 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010337
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010338 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10339 Sets a variable.
10340
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010341 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10342 Unsets a variable.
10343
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010344 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10345 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10346 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10347 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10348
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010349 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10350 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10351 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10352 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10353
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010354 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10355 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10356 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10357 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10358 continues.
10359
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010360 - "silent-drop" :
10361 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010362 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010363 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10364 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10365 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10366 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10367 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010368 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10369 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010370 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10371 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010372 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010373 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10374 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10375 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10376 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10377
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010378 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10379 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10380
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010381 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10382 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10383 for changing the default action to a reject.
10384
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010385 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10386 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10387 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10388 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010389 period.
10390
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010391 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10392 declared inline.
10393
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010394 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10395 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010399 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010401 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10403 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010405 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10406 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010407
10408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10409 followed by some converters.
10410
10411 Example:
10412
10413 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10414
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010415 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10416 <var-name>.
10417
10418 Example:
10419
10420 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10421
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010422 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10423 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10424 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10425 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10426 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10427
10428 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10429
10430 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10431
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010432 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10433
10434 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10435
10436
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010437tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10438 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10440 no | yes | yes | no
10441 Arguments :
10442 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10443 below.
10444
10445 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010447 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010448 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10449 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10450 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10451 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10452 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10453 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10454 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010455 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010456 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10457 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10458 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10459 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10460 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10461 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10462 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10463 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10464 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10465 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10466 instead.
10467
10468 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10469 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10470 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10471 rules which may be inserted.
10472
10473 Several types of actions are supported :
10474 - accept : the request is accepted
10475 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10476 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10477 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010478 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010479 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10480 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010481 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010482 - silent-drop
10483
10484 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10485 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10486 sections for a complete description.
10487
10488 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10489 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10490 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10491
10492 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10493 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10494 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10495 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10496 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10497
10498 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10499 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10500
10501 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10502 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10503 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10504
10505 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10506 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10507 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10508
10509 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10510 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10511 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10512
10513 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10514 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10515 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10516
10517 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10518
10519 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10520
10521
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010522tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10523 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10525 no | no | yes | yes
10526 Arguments :
10527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10529 as explained at the top of this document.
10530
10531 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10532
10533
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010534timeout check <timeout>
10535 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10536 established.
10537
10538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10539 yes | no | yes | yes
10540 Arguments:
10541 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10543 as explained at the top of this document.
10544
10545 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10546 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010547 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010548 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010549 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10550 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10551 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010552
10553 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10554 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10555
10556 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10557 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010558 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010559
10560 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10561 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10562 forget about it.
10563
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010564 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10565 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010566
10567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010568timeout client <timeout>
10569timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10570 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10572 yes | yes | yes | no
10573 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010574 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010575 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10576 as explained at the top of this document.
10577
10578 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10579 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10580 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010581 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10582 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10583 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10584 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010585 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10586 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10587 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010588 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010589 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10591 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010592 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10593 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010594
10595 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10596 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10597 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10598 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010599 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010600 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10601
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010602 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010604 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10605 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10606 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10607
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010608 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10609 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010610
10611
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010612timeout client-fin <timeout>
10613 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10615 yes | yes | yes | no
10616 Arguments :
10617 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10618 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10619 as explained at the top of this document.
10620
10621 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10622 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10623 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10624 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10625 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10626 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10627 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010628 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10629 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10630 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010631
10632 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10633 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10634 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10635
10636 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10637
10638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010639timeout connect <timeout>
10640timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10641 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10643 yes | no | yes | yes
10644 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010645 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010646 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10647 as explained at the top of this document.
10648
10649 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010650 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010651 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010652 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010653 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10654 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010655
10656 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10657 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10658 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10659 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010660 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010661 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10662
10663 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10664 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10665 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10666
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010667 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10668 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010669
10670
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010671timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10672 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10674 yes | yes | yes | yes
10675 Arguments :
10676 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10677 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10678 as explained at the top of this document.
10679
10680 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10681 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10682 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10683 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10684 once the request has started to present itself.
10685
10686 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10687 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10688 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10689 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10690 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10691
10692 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10693 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10694 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10695 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10696
10697 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10698 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010699 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010700 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10701 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010702 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010703
10704 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10705 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10706 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10707 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10708
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010709 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10710 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010711 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10712
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010713 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10714
10715
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010716timeout http-request <timeout>
10717 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010719 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010720 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010721 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010722 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10723 as explained at the top of this document.
10724
10725 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10726 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10727 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10728 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10729 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10730 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10731 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010732 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10733 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10734 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10735 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010736 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010737 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10738 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010739
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010740 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10741 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10742 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10743 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10744 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010745 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010746
10747 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10748 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010749 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010750 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10751 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10752
10753 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010754 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10755 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10756 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010757
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010758 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010759 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010760
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010761
10762timeout queue <timeout>
10763 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10765 yes | no | yes | yes
10766 Arguments :
10767 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10769 as explained at the top of this document.
10770
10771 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10772 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10773 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10774 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10775 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10776
10777 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10778 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10779 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10780 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10781
10782 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10783
10784
10785timeout server <timeout>
10786timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10787 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10789 yes | no | yes | yes
10790 Arguments :
10791 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10792 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10793 as explained at the top of this document.
10794
10795 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10796 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10797 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10798 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10799 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10800 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10801 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10802
10803 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10804 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10805 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10806 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10807 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010808 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010809 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010810 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10811 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010812 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10813 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010814
10815 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10816 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10817 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10818 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010819 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010820 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10821
10822 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10823 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10824 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10825
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010826 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010827
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010828
10829timeout server-fin <timeout>
10830 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10832 yes | no | yes | yes
10833 Arguments :
10834 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10835 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10836 as explained at the top of this document.
10837
10838 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10839 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10840 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10841 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10842 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10843 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10844 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10845 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10846 situations, it should not be needed.
10847
10848 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10849 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10850 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10851
10852 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10853
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010854
10855timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010856 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10858 yes | yes | yes | yes
10859 Arguments :
10860 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10862 as explained at the top of this document.
10863
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010864 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10865 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10866 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10867 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010868
10869 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10870 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10871 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10872 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010873 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010874
10875 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10876
10877
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010878timeout tunnel <timeout>
10879 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10881 yes | no | yes | yes
10882 Arguments :
10883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10885 as explained at the top of this document.
10886
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010887 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010888 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10889 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10890 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010891 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10892 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010893 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10894 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10895 specified.
10896
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010897 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10898 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10899 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10900 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10901 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10902 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10903 state.
10904
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010905 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10906 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10907 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10908 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010909 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010910
10911 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10912 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10913 forget about it.
10914
10915 Example :
10916 defaults http
10917 option http-server-close
10918 timeout connect 5s
10919 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010920 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010921 timeout server 30s
10922 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10923
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010925
10926
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010927transparent (deprecated)
10928 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010930 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010931 Arguments : none
10932
10933 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10934 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10935 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10936 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10937 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10938 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10939 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10940 appropriate server.
10941
10942 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10943
10944 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10945 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10946
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010947 See also: "option transparent"
10948
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010949unique-id-format <string>
10950 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10952 yes | yes | yes | no
10953 Arguments :
10954 <string> is a log-format string.
10955
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010956 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10957 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10958 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10959 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010960
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010961 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10962 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10963 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10964 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10965 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10966 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10967 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10968 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010969
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010970 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10971 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010972
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010973 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010974
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010975 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010976
10977 will generate:
10978
10979 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10980
10981 See also: "unique-id-header"
10982
10983unique-id-header <name>
10984 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10986 yes | yes | yes | no
10987 Arguments :
10988 <name> is the name of the header.
10989
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010990 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10991 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010992
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010993 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010994
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010995 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010996 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10997
10998 will generate:
10999
11000 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11001
11002 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011003
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011004use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011005 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11007 no | yes | yes | no
11008 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011009 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11010 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011011
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011012 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11013 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011014
11015 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11016 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11017 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011018 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011020 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11021 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011022
11023 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11024 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11025 assign the backend.
11026
11027 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11028 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11029 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11030 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11031 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11032 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11033
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011034 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011035 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011036 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11037 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11038 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11039
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011040 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11041 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11042 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11043 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11044 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11045 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11046 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11047 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11048 cannot be forced from the request.
11049
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011050 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011051 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11052 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11053
11054 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11055 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011056
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011057
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011058use-server <server> if <condition>
11059use-server <server> unless <condition>
11060 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11062 no | no | yes | yes
11063 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011064 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011065
11066 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11067
11068 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11069 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11070 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11071
11072 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11073 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11074 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11075 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11076 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11077 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11078 matches will assign the server.
11079
11080 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11081 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11082 with the next rules until one matches.
11083
11084 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11085 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11086 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11087 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11088
11089 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11090 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11091 stripped.
11092
11093 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11094 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11095 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11096 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11097
11098 Example :
11099 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11100 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11101 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11102 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11103 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11104 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011105 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011106 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11107 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11108
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011109 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011110
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011111
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111125. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011113--------------------------
11114
11115The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11116depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11117settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11118written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11119described in this section.
11120
11121
111225.1. Bind options
11123-----------------
11124
11125The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11126as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11127no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11128parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11129while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11130provided immediately after the setting name.
11131
11132The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11133
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011134accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11135 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11136 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11137 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11138 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11139 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11140 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11141 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11142 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11143 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011144 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11145 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11146 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011148accept-proxy
11149 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011150 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11151 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011152 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11153 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11154 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11155 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011156 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011157 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11158 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011159 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11160 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011161
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011162allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011163 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011164 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011165 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011166 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11167 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011168
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011169alpn <protocols>
11170 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11171 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11172 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011173 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011174 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011175 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11176 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11177 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11178 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11179 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11180 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11181 preference, like below :
11182
11183 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011185backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011186 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011187 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11188
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011189curves <curves>
11190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11191 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11192 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11193 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11194 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11195 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11196
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011197ecdhe <named curve>
11198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011199 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11200 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011201
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011202ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11204 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11205 client's certificate.
11206
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011207ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11209 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11210 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11211 error is ignored.
11212
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011213ca-sign-file <cafile>
11214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11215 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11216 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11217 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11218 'generate-certificates' for details.
11219
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011220ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11222 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11223 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11224 'generate-certificates' for details.
11225
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011226ciphers <ciphers>
11227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11228 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011229 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011230 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011231 information and recommendations see e.g.
11232 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11233 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11234 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11235
11236ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11238 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11239 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11240 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011241 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11242 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011243
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011244crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011245 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11246 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11247 to verify client's certificate.
11248
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011249crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011250 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11251 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11252 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11253 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11254 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11255 file.
11256
11257 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11258 are loaded.
11259
11260 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011261 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011262 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11263 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11264 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11265 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011266 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11267 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011268 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011269
11270 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11271 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11272 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11273 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011274 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11275 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011276
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011277 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011279 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011280 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011281 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11282 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011283 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11284 clients).
11285
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011286 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11287 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11288 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11289 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11290 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11291 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11292 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11293 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11294 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11295 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11296 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11297 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11298 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11299
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011300 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11301 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11302 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11303 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11304 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11305
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011306 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11307 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11308 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11309 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011310
11311 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11312 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11313 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11314 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11315 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11316 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11317 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11318 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11319 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11320
11321 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11322
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011323 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011324 a cert bundle.
11325
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011326 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011327 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11328 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11329 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11330 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11331 provide multi-cert support.
11332
11333 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11334
11335 Filename | CN | SAN
11336 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11337 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011338 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011339 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11340 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11341
11342 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11343 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11344 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11345 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011346 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11347 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11348 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011349
11350 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11351 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11352
11353 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11354 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11355 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11356
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011357crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011359 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011360 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011361 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011362
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011363crt-list <file>
11364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011365 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11366 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011367
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011368 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11369
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011370 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11371 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011372 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011373 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011374
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011375 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11376 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11377 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11378 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11379 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11380 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11381 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11382 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011383
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011384 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011385 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011386 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11387 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11388 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011389
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011390 crt-list file example:
11391 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011392 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011393 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011394 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011396defer-accept
11397 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11398 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11399 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011400 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011401 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11402 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11403 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11404 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11405 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11406 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11407 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11408
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011409expose-fd listeners
11410 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11411 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011412 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11413 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011414 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011415
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011416force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011417 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011418 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011419 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011420 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011421
11422force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011423 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011424 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011425 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011426
11427force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011428 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011429 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011430 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011431
11432force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011433 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011434 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011435 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011436
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011437force-tlsv13
11438 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11439 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011440 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011441
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011442generate-certificates
11443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11444 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11445 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11446 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11447 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11448 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11449 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11450 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11451 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11452 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11453 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11454
11455 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11456 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011457 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011458 certificate is used many times.
11459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011460gid <gid>
11461 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11462 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11463 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11464 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11465 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11466
11467group <group>
11468 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11469 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11470 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11471 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11472 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11473
11474id <id>
11475 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11476 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11477 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11478 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11479
11480interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011481 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11482 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11483 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11484 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11485 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11486 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011487 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11488 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11489 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11490 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11491 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11492 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011493
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011494level <level>
11495 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11496 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11497 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011498 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011499 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11500 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11501 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011502 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011503 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011505 all counters).
11506
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011507severity-output <format>
11508 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11509 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11510 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11511 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11512 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11513 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11514 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11515 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11516 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11517 rfc5424 convention.
11518
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011519maxconn <maxconn>
11520 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11521 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11522 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11523 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11524 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11525 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11526 eat all memory.
11527
11528mode <mode>
11529 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11530 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11531 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11532 UNIX sockets.
11533
11534mss <maxseg>
11535 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11536 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11537 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11538 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11539 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11540 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11541 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11542 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11543 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11544 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11545 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11546
11547name <name>
11548 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11549 page.
11550
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011551namespace <name>
11552 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11553 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11554 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11555 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11556
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011557nice <nice>
11558 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11559 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11560 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11561 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11562 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11563 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11564 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11565 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11566 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11567 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11568 one for an RDP socket.
11569
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011570no-ca-names
11571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11572 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11573
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011574no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011576 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011577 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011578 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011579 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11580 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011581
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011582no-tls-tickets
11583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11584 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11585 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011586 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11587 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011588
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011589no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011591 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011592 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011593 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011594 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11595 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011596
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011597no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011599 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011600 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011601 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011602 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11603 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011604
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011605no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011607 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011608 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011609 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011610 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11611 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011612
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011613no-tlsv13
11614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11615 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11616 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11617 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011618 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11619 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011620
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011621npn <protocols>
11622 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11623 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11624 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011625 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011626 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011627 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11628 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11629 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11630 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11631 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011632
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011633prefer-client-ciphers
11634 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11635 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11636 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011637 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11638 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11639 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011640
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011641process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011642 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011643 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011644 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011645 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11646 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11647 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11648 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011650 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11651 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11652 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11653 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11654 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011655
11656 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11657
11658 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11659 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11660 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11661 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11662 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11663 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11664 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11665 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011666
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011667proto <name>
11668 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11669 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11670 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11671 in haproxy -vv.
11672 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11673 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011674 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011675 h2" on the bind line.
11676
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011677ssl
11678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011679 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011680 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11681 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011682 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11683 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011684
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011685ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11686 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11687 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11688 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11689
11690ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11691 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11692 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11693 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11694
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011695strict-sni
11696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11697 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11698 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11699 See the "crt" option for more information.
11700
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011701tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011702 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011703 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11704 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011705 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011706 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11707 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11708 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11709 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11710 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11711 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11712 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11713
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011714tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011715 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011716 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11717 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11718 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11719 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11720 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11721 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11722 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011723 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11724 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11725 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011726
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011727tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11728 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011729 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11730 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11731 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11732 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11733 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11734 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11735 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11736 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11737 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11738 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011739 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11740 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11741
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011742transparent
11743 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11744 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11745 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11746 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11747 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11748 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11749 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11750 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11751 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11752 so check for support with your vendor.
11753
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011754v4v6
11755 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11756 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11757 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11758 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011759 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011760
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011761v6only
11762 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11763 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11764 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011765 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11766 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011768uid <uid>
11769 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11770 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11771 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11772 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11773 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11774
11775user <user>
11776 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11777 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11778 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11779 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11780 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11781
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011782verify [none|optional|required]
11783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11784 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11785 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11786 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11787 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011788 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11789 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11790 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11791 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011792
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117935.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011794------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011795
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011796The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11797which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11798arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11799settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11800after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11801Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11802address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011804 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011805 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011806
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011807Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11808keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011810The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011811
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011812addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011813 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011814 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11815 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11816 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11817 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11818 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011819
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011820agent-check
11821 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011822 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011823 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11824 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11825 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011826
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011827 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011828 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011829 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11830 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11831 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011833 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11834 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11835 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11836 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11837 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011838
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011839 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011840 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011841
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011842 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11843 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11844 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011845
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011846 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11847 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11848 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011849
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011850 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11851 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11852 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11853 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11854 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011855 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011856 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011857
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011858 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11859 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011860
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011861 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11862 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11863 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11864 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11865 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11866 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11867 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11868 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11869 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011870
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011871 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11872 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011873 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11874 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11875 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011876 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011877
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011878 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011879 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011880
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011881agent-send <string>
11882 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11883 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11884 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11885 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11886 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11887
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011888agent-inter <delay>
11889 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11890 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11891
11892 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11893 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11894 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11895 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11896 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11897 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11898 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11899 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11900 of backends use the same servers.
11901
11902 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11903
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011904agent-addr <addr>
11905 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11906
11907 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11908 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11909 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11910 hostname, it will be resolved.
11911
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011912agent-port <port>
11913 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11914
11915 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11916
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011917allow-0rtt
11918 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011919 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11920 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011921
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011922alpn <protocols>
11923 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11924 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11925 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011926 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011927 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11928 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11929 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11930 now obsolete NPN extension.
11931 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11932 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11933
11934 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011936backup
11937 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11938 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11939 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11940 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011941 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11942 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011943
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011944ca-file <cafile>
11945 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11946 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11947 server's certificate.
11948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011949check
11950 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011951 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11952 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11953 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11954 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11955 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11956 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11957 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011958 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11959 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011960 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11961 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011962
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011963check-send-proxy
11964 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11965 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11966 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11967 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11968 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11969 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11970 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11971
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011972check-alpn <protocols>
11973 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11974 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11975 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11976
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011977check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011978 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011979 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11980 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011981
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011982check-ssl
11983 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11984 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11985 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11986 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011987 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011988 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11989 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011990 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011991 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11992 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011993
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011994check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011995 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011996 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11997 for normal traffic.
11998
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011999ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12001 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12002 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012003 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12004 information and recommendations see e.g.
12005 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12006 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12007 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012008
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012009ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12010 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12011 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12012 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12013 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012014 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12015 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12016 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012018cookie <value>
12019 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12020 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12021 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12022 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12023 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12024 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12025 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12026
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012027crl-file <crlfile>
12028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12029 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12030 to verify server's certificate.
12031
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012032crt <cert>
12033 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12034 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12035 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12036 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12037 certificate request.
12038
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012039disabled
12040 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12041 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12042 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12043 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12044 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012045 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012046
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012047enabled
12048 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12049 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12050 default value.
12051 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12052 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012054error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012055 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12056 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12057 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012059 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012061fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012062 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12063 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12064 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12065
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012066force-sslv3
12067 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12068 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012069 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012070 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012071
12072force-tlsv10
12073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012074 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012075 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012076
12077force-tlsv11
12078 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012079 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012080 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012081
12082force-tlsv12
12083 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012084 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012085 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012086
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012087force-tlsv13
12088 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12089 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012090 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012092id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012093 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12094 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12095 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012096
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012097init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12098 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12099 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012100 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012101 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12102 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12103 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12104 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12105 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12106 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12107 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12108 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12109 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012110 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012111 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12112 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12113 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12114 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12115 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12116 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012117 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012118
12119 Example:
12120 defaults
12121 # never fail on address resolution
12122 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012124inter <delay>
12125fastinter <delay>
12126downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012127 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12128 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12129 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12130 between checks depending on the server state :
12131
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012132 Server state | Interval used
12133 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12134 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12135 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12136 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12137 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12138 or yet unchecked. |
12139 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12140 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12141 | "inter" otherwise.
12142 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012144 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12145 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12146 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12147 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012148 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12149 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12150 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12151 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12152 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012154maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012155 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12156 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12157 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12158 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12159 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12160 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12161 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12162 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012164maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012165 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12166 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12167 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12168 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12169 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12170 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12171 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12172
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012173max-reuse <count>
12174 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12175 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12176 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12177 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12178 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12179 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12180 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12181 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012183minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012184 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12185 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12186 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12187 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12188 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12189 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012190 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012192
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012193namespace <name>
12194 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12195 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12196 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12197 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12198
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012199no-agent-check
12200 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12201 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12202 default value.
12203 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12204 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12205
12206no-backup
12207 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12208 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12209 default value.
12210 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12211 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12212
12213no-check
12214 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12215 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12216 default value.
12217 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12218 "default-server" "check" setting.
12219
12220no-check-ssl
12221 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12222 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12223 default value.
12224 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12225 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12226
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012227no-send-proxy
12228 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12229 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12230 default value.
12231 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12232 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12233
12234no-send-proxy-v2
12235 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12236 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12237 default value.
12238 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12239 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12240
12241no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12242 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12243 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12244 default value.
12245 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12246 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12247
12248no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12249 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12250 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12251 default value.
12252 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12253 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12254
12255no-ssl
12256 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12257 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12258 default value.
12259 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12260 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12261
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012262no-ssl-reuse
12263 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12264 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12265 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12266 and for paranoid users.
12267
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012268no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012269 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12270 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012271 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012272
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012273 Supported in default-server: No
12274
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012275no-tls-tickets
12276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12277 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12278 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012279 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12280 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012281 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012282
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012283no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012284 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012285 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12286 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012287 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12288 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012289 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012290
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012291 Supported in default-server: No
12292
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012293no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012294 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012295 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12296 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012297 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12298 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012299 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012300
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012301 Supported in default-server: No
12302
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012303no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012304 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012305 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12306 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012307 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12308 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012309 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012310
12311 Supported in default-server: No
12312
12313no-tlsv13
12314 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12315 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12316 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12317 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12318 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012319 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012320
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012321 Supported in default-server: No
12322
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012323no-verifyhost
12324 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12325 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12326 default value.
12327 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12328 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012329
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012330no-tfo
12331 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12332 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12333 default value.
12334 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12335 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12336
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012337non-stick
12338 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12339 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12340 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12341
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012342npn <protocols>
12343 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12344 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12345 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012346 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012347 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12348 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12349 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012351observe <mode>
12352 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12353 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12354 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12355 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12356 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12357 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012358 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012359
12360 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012362on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012363 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12364 Currently, four modes are available:
12365 - fastinter: force fastinter
12366 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12367 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12368 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12369 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12370
12371 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12372
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012373on-marked-down <action>
12374 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12375 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012376 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12377 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12378 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12379 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12380 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12381 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12382 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12383 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012384
12385 Actions are disabled by default
12386
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012387on-marked-up <action>
12388 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12389 Currently one action is available:
12390 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12391 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12392 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12393 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012394 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12395 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012396 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12397 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12398
12399 Actions are disabled by default
12400
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012401pool-max-conn <max>
12402 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12403 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12404 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12405 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12406 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12407 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12408
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012409pool-purge-delay <delay>
12410 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012411 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012412 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012414port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012415 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12416 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12417 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12418 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12419 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12420 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12421
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012422proto <name>
12423
12424 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12425 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12426 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12427 reported in haproxy -vv.
12428 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12429 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012431redir <prefix>
12432 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12433 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12434 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12435 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12436 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12437 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12438 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12439 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012440 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012441 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012442 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12443 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12444 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12445 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12446
12447 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012449rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012450 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12451 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12452 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12453
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012454resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12455 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12456 server.
12457
12458 Available options:
12459
12460 * allow-dup-ip
12461 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12462 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12463 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12464 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12465 For such case, simply enable this option.
12466 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12467
12468 * prevent-dup-ip
12469 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12470 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12471 same fqdn.
12472 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12473
12474 Example:
12475 backend b_myapp
12476 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12477 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12478 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12479
12480 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12481 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12482 it
12483 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12484 different address
12485
12486 Default value: not set
12487
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012488resolve-prefer <family>
12489 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12490 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12491 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12492 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12493
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012494 Default value: ipv6
12495
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012496 Example:
12497
12498 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012499
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012500resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012501 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012502 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012503 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012504 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12505 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012506 configured network, another address is selected.
12507
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012508 Example:
12509
12510 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012511
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012512resolvers <id>
12513 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12514 hostname.
12515
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012516 Example:
12517
12518 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012519
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012520 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012521
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012522send-proxy
12523 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12524 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12525 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12526 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012527 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12528 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12529 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12530 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12531 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12532 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12533 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12534 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12535 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12536 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012537 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12538 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012539
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012540send-proxy-v2
12541 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12542 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12543 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12544 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012545 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12546 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12547 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12548 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012549
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012550proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12551 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12552 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012553 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12554 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012555 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12556 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012557 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012558
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012559send-proxy-v2-ssl
12560 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12561 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12562 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12563 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12564 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12565 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12566 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012567 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12568 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012569
12570send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12571 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12572 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12573 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12574 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12575 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12576 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12577 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12578 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012579 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12580 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012582slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012583 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12584 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12585 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12586 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12587 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12588 parameters :
12589
12590 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12591 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12592
12593 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12594 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12595 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12596 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12597
12598 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12599 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12600 seen as failed.
12601
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012602sni <expression>
12603 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12604 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12605 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12606 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012607 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12608 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012609 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012610 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12611 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012612
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012613source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012614source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012615source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012616 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12617 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12618 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12619 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12620
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012621 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12622 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12623 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12624 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12625 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12626 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12627 server.
12628
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012629 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12630 specifying the source address without port(s).
12631
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012632ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012633 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12634 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12635 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12636 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12637 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12638 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012639 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12640 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012641
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012642ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12643 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12644 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12645 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12646
12647ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12648 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12649 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12650 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12651
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012652ssl-reuse
12653 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12654 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12655 default value.
12656 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12657 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12658
12659stick
12660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12662 default value.
12663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12664 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012665
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012666socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012667 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012668 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12669 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12670
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012671tcp-ut <delay>
12672 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12673 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12674 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012675 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012676 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12677 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12678 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12679 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12680 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12681 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12682 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12683 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12684 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12685
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012686tfo
12687 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12688 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12689 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12690 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12691 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012692 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012694track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012695 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12696 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12697 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12698 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012699 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12700
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012701tls-tickets
12702 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12703 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12704 default value.
12705 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12706 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012707
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012708verify [none|required]
12709 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012710 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012711 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12712 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012713 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012714 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12715 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12716 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12717 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12718 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12719 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12720 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12721 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012722
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012723verifyhost <hostname>
12724 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012725 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12726 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12727 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12728 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12729 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12730 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12731 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12732 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012733
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012734weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012735 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12736 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12737 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012738 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12739 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12740 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12741 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12742 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12743 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744
12745
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127465.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12747-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012748
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012749HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12750using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12751configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012752This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12753can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12754workload.
12755This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12756resolution at run time.
12757Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12758carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12759
12760
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127615.3.1. Global overview
12762----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012763
12764As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12765different steps of the process life:
12766
12767 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12768 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12769 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12770
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012771 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12772 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012773
12774A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12775 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12776 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12777 resolution to know this new IP.
12778
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012779When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012780HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012781SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12782from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12783will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12784will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012785
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012786A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012787 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012788 first valid response.
12789
12790 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12791 servers return an error.
12792
12793
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127945.3.2. The resolvers section
12795----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012796
12797This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012798HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12799contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012800
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012801When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12802uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12803is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12804answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12805
12806When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012807used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012808
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012809 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12810 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12811 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012812
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012813 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12814 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012815
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012816 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12817 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12818 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012819
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012820For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12821following scenarios are possible:
12822
12823 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12824 ignored
12825
12826 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12827 applied
12828
12829 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12830 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12831
12832 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12833 retries the query with a new type
12834
12835 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12836 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012837
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012838As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12839a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012840<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012841
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012842
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012843resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012844 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012845
12846A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12847
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012848accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012849 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012850 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012851 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12852 by RFC 6891)
12853
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012854 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12855
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012856nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12857 DNS server description:
12858 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12859 <ip> : IP address of the server
12860 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12861
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012862parse-resolv-conf
12863 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12864 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12865 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12866
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012867hold <status> <period>
12868 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12869 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012870 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012871 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012872 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12873 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12874 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12875
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012876 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012877
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012878resolve_retries <nb>
12879 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12880 giving up.
12881 Default value: 3
12882
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012883 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12884 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12885 type.
12886
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012887timeout <event> <time>
12888 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12889 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12890 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012891 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12892 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012893 Default value: 1s
12894 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012895 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012896 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012897 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12898 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12899
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012900 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012901
12902 resolvers mydns
12903 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12904 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012905 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012906 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012907 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012908 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012909 hold other 30s
12910 hold refused 30s
12911 hold nx 30s
12912 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012913 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012914 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012915
12916
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129176. HTTP header manipulation
12918---------------------------
12919
12920In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12921response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12922request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12923which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012924against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012925
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012926If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12927to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12928but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12929HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12930stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12931because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12932a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12933still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012935This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12936in section 4.2 :
12937
12938 - reqadd <string>
12939 - reqallow <search>
12940 - reqiallow <search>
12941 - reqdel <search>
12942 - reqidel <search>
12943 - reqdeny <search>
12944 - reqideny <search>
12945 - reqpass <search>
12946 - reqipass <search>
12947 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12948 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12949 - reqtarpit <search>
12950 - reqitarpit <search>
12951 - rspadd <string>
12952 - rspdel <search>
12953 - rspidel <search>
12954 - rspdeny <search>
12955 - rspideny <search>
12956 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12957 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12958
12959With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12960is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12961parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12962prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12963Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12964
12965 \t for a tab
12966 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12967 \n for a new line (LF)
12968 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12969 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12970 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12971 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12972 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12973
12974The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12975portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12976above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12977regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
129789 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12979is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12980
12981The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12982after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12983
12984Notes related to these keywords :
12985---------------------------------
12986 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12987 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12988 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12989
12990 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12991 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12992 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12993
12994 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12995 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12996 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12997 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12998 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12999
13000 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13001 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13002 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13003 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13004 useless headers before adding new ones.
13005
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013006 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013007 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13008
13009 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13010 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13011 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13012
13013 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13014 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013015 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013016
13017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130187. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13019----------------------------------
13020
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013021HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013022client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13023The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13024these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13025but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13026data called patterns.
13027
13028
130297.1. ACL basics
13030---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013031
13032The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13033content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13034from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13035simple :
13036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013037 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013038 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13040 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13043adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013044
13045In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013048
13049This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13050Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13051and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013052an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13053conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13054as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13055are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013056
13057ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13058'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13059which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13060
13061There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13062performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13065specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13066this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013067methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13068ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013069
13070Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13071 - boolean
13072 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13073 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13074 - string
13075 - data block
13076
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013077Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13078converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13079would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13080The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13081which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13082
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013083Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13084keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13085fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13086which are summarized in the table below :
13087
13088 +---------------------+-----------------+
13089 | Sample or converter | Default |
13090 | output type | matching method |
13091 +---------------------+-----------------+
13092 | boolean | bool |
13093 +---------------------+-----------------+
13094 | integer | int |
13095 +---------------------+-----------------+
13096 | ip | ip |
13097 +---------------------+-----------------+
13098 | string | str |
13099 +---------------------+-----------------+
13100 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13101 +---------------------+-----------------+
13102
13103Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13104matching method, see below.
13105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13107 - boolean
13108 - integer or integer range
13109 - IP address / network
13110 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13111 - regular expression
13112 - hex block
13113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013114The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13115
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013116 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13117 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013118 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013119 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013120 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013121 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013122 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13125read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13126if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13127lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13128will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13129beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13130a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13131lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13132exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13133
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013134The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13135parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13136ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13137a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13138check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13139
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013140The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13141socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13142file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013144Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13145loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13146
13147 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13148
13149In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13150the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13151case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13152as well.
13153
13154The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13155sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13156do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13157methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13158is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013159obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13161default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13162that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13163string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13164
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013165The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13166By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13167string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13168resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13169server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013170waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013171flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13172function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13175sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13176be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013177
13178 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13179 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13181 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13182 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13183 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013184
13185 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13186 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013188
13189 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013190 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013191
13192 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013193 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013194
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013195 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013196 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13197
13198 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13199 binary or string samples.
13200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13202 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13205 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13206 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13209 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13212 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013214 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13215 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13218 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013219 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13222 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13223 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013224
13225For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13226request, it is possible to do :
13227
13228 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13229
13230In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13231buffer, one would use the following acl :
13232
13233 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13234
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013235On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13236possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13237
13238 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13241criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13242method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13243to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13244criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13245the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013247If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013248the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13249For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013251 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13252 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13253 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13254 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013255
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013256
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013257The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13258types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13259combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13260brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13261default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263 +-------------------------------------------------+
13264 | Input sample type |
13265 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013266 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13268 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13269 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013270 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013272 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013273 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013274 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013275 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013276 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013278 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013280 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013281 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013282 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013284 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013286 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013288 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013290 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13292 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13293 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013294
13295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132967.1.1. Matching booleans
13297------------------------
13298
13299In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13300Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13301When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13302that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13303
13304Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13305return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13306"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133097.1.2. Matching integers
13310------------------------
13311
13312Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13313enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13314to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13315
13316Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13317matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13318lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013319
13320For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13321unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13322representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13323
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013324As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13325two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13326instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13327ranges and operators.
13328
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013329For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013330operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13331Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13332of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013334Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013335
13336 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13337 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13338 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13339 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13340 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013342For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013343
13344 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13345
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013346This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13347
13348 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13349
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133517.1.3. Matching strings
13352-----------------------
13353
13354String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13355different forms :
13356
13357 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013358 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359
13360 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013361 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362
13363 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13364 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13365
13366 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13367 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13368
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013369 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013370 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13371 matches.
13372
13373 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13374 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13375 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013376
13377String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13378exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13379characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13380string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13381to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013382before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013383
13384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133857.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13386---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013387
13388Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13389they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13390possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13391passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13392the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013393the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13394match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013395
13396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133977.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13398-------------------------------------
13399
13400It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13401not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13402a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13403to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13404digits may be used upper or lower case.
13405
13406Example :
13407 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13408 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13409
13410
134117.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13412---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013413
13414IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13415netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13416within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013417host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013418difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13419at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13420does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13421parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013422
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013423The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13424abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13425
13426 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13427 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13428 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13429 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13430 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13431 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13432 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13433 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13434
13435Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13436192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13437
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013438IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13439Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13440trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13441IPv6 patterns.
13442
13443HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13444following situations :
13445 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13446 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13447 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13448 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13449 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13450 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13451 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13452 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13453 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13454 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456
134577.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13458----------------------------------
13459
13460Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13461combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13462
13463 - AND (implicit)
13464 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13465 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13472indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13475"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13476requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13477is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13478
13479 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013480 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13481 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13482 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483
13484To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13485and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13486
13487 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13488 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13489 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13490 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13491
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013492 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13494 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13495 use_backend www if host_www
13496
13497It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13498expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13499be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13500the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13501
13502 The following rule :
13503
13504 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013505 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013506
13507 Can also be written that way :
13508
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013509 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510
13511It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13512to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13513simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13514sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13515good use is the following :
13516
13517 With named ACLs :
13518
13519 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13520 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13521 monitor fail if site_dead
13522
13523 With anonymous ACLs :
13524
13525 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13526
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013527See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13528keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529
13530
135317.3. Fetching samples
13532---------------------
13533
13534Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13535against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13536sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13537ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13538of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13539available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13540
13541This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13542Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13543compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13544deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13545
13546The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13547matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13548method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13549indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13550
13551As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13552when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13553mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13554the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13555ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13556
13557Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13558multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13559when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013560incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13561are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013562is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13563all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13564
13565Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13566 - name
13567 - name(arg1)
13568 - name(arg1,arg2)
13569
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013570
135717.3.1. Converters
13572-----------------
13573
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013574Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13575of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13576is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13577was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013578has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013579unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13580
13581These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13582sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13583the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013584support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013585
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013586A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13587support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13588supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13589(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13590bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013593
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001359451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13595 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13596 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13597 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13598 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13599 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13600
13601 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13603 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013604 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13605 frontend http-in
13606 bind *:8081
13607 default_backend servers
13608 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13609 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13610
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013611add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013612 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013613 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013614 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13615 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13619 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13620 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013621 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013622 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013623
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013624aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13625 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13626 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13627 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13628 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13629 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13630 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13631
13632 Example:
13633 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13634 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13635
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013636and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013637 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013638 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013639 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13640 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013641 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013642 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13643 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13644 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13645 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013646 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013647 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013648
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013649b64dec
13650 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13651 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13652
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013653base64
13654 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013655 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013656 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13657
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013658bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013659 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013660 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013661 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013662 presence of a flag).
13663
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013664bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13665 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13666 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013667 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013668
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013669concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13670 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13671 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13672 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13673 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13674 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13675 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13676 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13677 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13678 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13679 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013680 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013681 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013682 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013683
13684 Example:
13685 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13686 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13687 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13688 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13689
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013690cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013691 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13692 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013693
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013694crc32([<avalanche>])
13695 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13696 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13697 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13698 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13699 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13700 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13701 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13702 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13703 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13704 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013705 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13706
13707crc32c([<avalanche>])
13708 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13709 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13710 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13711 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13712 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13713 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13714 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13715 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013716
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013717da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013718 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13719 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13720 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13721 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013722 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013723 configuration language.
13724
13725 Example:
13726 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013727 bind *:8881
13728 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013729 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013730
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013731debug
13732 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13733 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13734 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13735
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013736div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013737 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13738 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013739 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013740 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13741 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013748 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013749
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013750djb2([<avalanche>])
13751 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13752 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13753 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13754 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13755 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13756 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13757 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013758 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13759 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013760
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013761even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013762 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013763 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13764
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013765field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13766 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13767 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13768 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13769 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13770 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13771 fields.
13772
13773 Example :
13774 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13775 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13776 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13777 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13778 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013779
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013780hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013781 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013782 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013783 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013784 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013785
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013786hex2i
13787 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013788 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013790http_date([<offset>])
13791 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13792 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13793 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13794 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13795 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13796 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013798in_table(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13801 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013802 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013803 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13804
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013805ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13806 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013807 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013808 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13809 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13810 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13811 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13812 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013813
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013814json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013815 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013816 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013817 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013818 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13819 of errors:
13820 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13821 bytes, ...)
13822 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13823 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13824
13825 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13826 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13827 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13828 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13829 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13830 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013831 - "ascii" : never fails;
13832 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13833 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013834 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013835 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013836 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13837 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13838
13839 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013840 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013841
13842 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013843 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013844 capture request header user-agent len 150
13845 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013846
13847 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13848 GET / HTTP/1.0
13849 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13850
13851 Output log:
13852 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13853
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013854language(<value>[,<default>])
13855 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13856 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13857 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13858 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13859 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13860 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13861 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13862 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13863 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013865 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13866 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013867
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013868 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013869
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013870 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13871 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013872
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013873 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13874 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13875 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13876 use_backend spanish if es
13877 use_backend french if fr
13878 use_backend english if en
13879 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013880
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013881length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013882 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13883 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13884 type. The result is of type integer.
13885
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013886lower
13887 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13888 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13889 type. The result is of type string.
13890
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013891ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13892 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13893 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13894 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13895 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13896 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13897 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13898
13899 Example :
13900
13901 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013902 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013903 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13904
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013905map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13906map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13907map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13908 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13909 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13910 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13911 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13912 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13913 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13914 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13915 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013917 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13918 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13919 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013920
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013921 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013922 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013923
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013924 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13925 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13926 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13927 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013928 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13929 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013930 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13931 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13932 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13933 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13934 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13935 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13936 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13937 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013938 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13939 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13940 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013941 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13942 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13943 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13944 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13945 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013946
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013947 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13948 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13949 the corresponding match text.
13950
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013951 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13952 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13953 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13954 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13955 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013957 Example :
13958
13959 # this is a comment and is ignored
13960 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13961 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13962 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13963 | | | `---------- value
13964 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13965 | `---------------------------- key
13966 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13967
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013968mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013969 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13970 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013971 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013972 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013973 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013974 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13975 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13976 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13977 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013978 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013979 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013980
13981mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013982 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013983 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13984 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013985 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013986 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013987 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013988 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13989 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013993 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013994
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013995nbsrv
13996 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13997 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13998 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13999 map lookup.
14000
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014001neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014002 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14003 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14004 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14005 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014006
14007not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014008 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014009 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014010 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014011 absence of a flag).
14012
14013odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014014 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014015 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14016
14017or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014018 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014019 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014020 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14021 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014022 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014023 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14024 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14025 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14026 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014027 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014028 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014029
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014030protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14031 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14032 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14033 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14034 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14035 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14036 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14037 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14038 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14039 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14040 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14041 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14042
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014043regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014044 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14045 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14046 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14047 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14048 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14049 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14050 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14051 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14052 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14053 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014054 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14055 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14056 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14057 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014058
14059 Example :
14060
14061 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14062 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14063 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14064 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14065
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014066capture-req(<id>)
14067 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14068 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14069
14070 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014071 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14072 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014073
14074capture-res(<id>)
14075 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14076 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14077
14078 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014079 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14080 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014081
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014082sdbm([<avalanche>])
14083 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14084 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14085 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14086 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14087 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14088 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14089 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014090 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14091 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014092
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014093set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014094 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14095 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14096 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014097 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014098 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14099 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014100 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014103 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014104 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014105
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014106sha1
14107 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14108 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14109
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014110strcmp(<var>)
14111 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14112 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14113 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14114 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14115 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14116 shorter).
14117
14118 Example :
14119
14120 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14121 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14122 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14123
14124
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014125sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014126 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14127 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014128 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014129 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14130 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014131 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014132 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14133 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014134 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014135 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14136 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014137 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014138 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014139
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014140table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14144 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14145 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14146 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14147
14148
14149table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14153 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14154 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14155 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14156
14157table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14158 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14159 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014161 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14162 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14163
14164table_conn_cur(<table>)
14165 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14166 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14167 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14168 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14169 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14170
14171table_conn_rate(<table>)
14172 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14173 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14174 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14175 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14176 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14177
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014178table_gpt0(<table>)
14179 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14180 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14181 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14182 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14183 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14184
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014185table_gpc0(<table>)
14186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14188 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14189 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14190 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14191
14192table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14193 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14194 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14195 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14196 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14197 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14198 sample fetch keyword.
14199
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014200table_gpc1(<table>)
14201 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14202 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14203 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14204 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14205 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14206
14207table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14208 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14209 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14210 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14211 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14212 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14213 sample fetch keyword.
14214
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014215table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14216 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14217 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014218 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014219 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14220 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14221
14222table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14223 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14224 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14225 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14226 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14227 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14228 keyword.
14229
14230table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014233 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014234 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14235 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14236
14237table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14238 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14239 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14240 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14241 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14242 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14243 keyword.
14244
14245table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14246 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14247 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014248 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014249 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14250 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14251 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14252 keyword.
14253
14254table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14255 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14256 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014257 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014258 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14259 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14260 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14261 keyword.
14262
14263table_server_id(<table>)
14264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14267 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14268 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14269 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14270
14271table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14272 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14273 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014274 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014275 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14276 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14277 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14278 keyword.
14279
14280table_sess_rate(<table>)
14281 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14282 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14283 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14284 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14285 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14286 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14287 keyword.
14288
14289table_trackers(<table>)
14290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14292 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14293 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14294 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14295 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14296 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14297 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14298 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14299 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14300
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014301upper
14302 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14303 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14304 type. The result is of type string.
14305
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014306url_dec
14307 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14308 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14309
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014310ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014311 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014312 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14313 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14314 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014315 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14316 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14317 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14318 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014319 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014320 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14321 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014322
14323 Example:
14324 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14325 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14326
14327 message Point {
14328 int32 latitude = 1;
14329 int32 longitude = 2;
14330 }
14331
14332 message PPoint {
14333 Point point = 59;
14334 }
14335
14336 message Rectangle {
14337 // One corner of the rectangle.
14338 PPoint lo = 48;
14339 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14340 PPoint hi = 49;
14341 }
14342
14343 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14344 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14345 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14346
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014347 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14348 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014349 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014350 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14351
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014352 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014353
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014354 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014355
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014356 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014357 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14358 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14359
14360 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14361 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14362 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14363
14364 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14365 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14366 interpret the previous binary sample.
14367
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014368
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014369unset-var(<var name>)
14370 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14371 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14372 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14373 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14374 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14375 response),
14376 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14377 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14378 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14379 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14380
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014381utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14382 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14383 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14384 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14385 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14386 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14387 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14388
14389 Example :
14390
14391 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014392 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014393 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14394
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014395word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14396 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14397 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14398 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14399 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14400 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14401
14402 Example :
14403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014408
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014409wt6([<avalanche>])
14410 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14411 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14412 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14413 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14414 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14415 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14416 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014417 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14418 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014419
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014420xor(<value>)
14421 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014422 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014423 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014424 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014425 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014426 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14427 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014428 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014429 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14430 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014431 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014432 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014433
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014434xxh32([<seed>])
14435 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14436 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14437 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14438 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14439 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14440 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14441 as cryptographically secure.
14442
14443xxh64([<seed>])
14444 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14445 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14446 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14447 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14448 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14449 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14450 as cryptographically secure.
14451
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014452
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144537.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454--------------------------------------------
14455
14456A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14457not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14458"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14459The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14460
14461always_false : boolean
14462 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14463 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14464
14465always_true : boolean
14466 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14467 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14468
14469avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014470 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14472 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14473 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14474 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14475 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14476 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14477 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14478 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14479 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14480 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14481 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14482 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14483 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014486 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14487 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14488 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14489 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014490 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14491
14492be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14493 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14494 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14495 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14496 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14497 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014498 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14499 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014500
14501 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14502 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14503 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14506 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14507 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14508 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014509 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14511 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014512
14513 Example :
14514 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14515 backend dynamic
14516 mode http
14517 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14518 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014519
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014520bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014521 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14522 of the string.
14523
14524bool(<bool>) : bool
14525 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14526 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014528connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14529 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014530 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014531 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14532 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014533
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014534 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014535 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014536 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14537
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014538 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14539 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014540
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014541 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014542 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014544 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014545 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014546 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014547 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014548
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014549 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14550 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014551 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014552 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014553
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014554cpu_calls : integer
14555 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14556 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14557 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14558 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14559 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14560 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14561
14562cpu_ns_avg : integer
14563 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14564 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14565 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14566 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14567 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14568 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14569 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14570 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14571 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14572 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14573 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14574
14575cpu_ns_tot : integer
14576 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14577 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14578 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14579 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14580 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14581 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14582 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14583 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14584 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14585 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14586 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14587 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14588 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14589
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014590date([<offset>]) : integer
14591 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14592 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14593 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14594 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014595 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14596
14597 Example :
14598
14599 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14600 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014601
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014602date_us : integer
14603 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14604 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14605 from the same timeval structure.
14606
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014607distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14608 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14609 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14610 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14611 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14612 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14613 list of supported tokens.
14614
14615distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14616 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14617 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14618 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14619 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14620 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14621 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14622 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14623 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14624 supported tokens.
14625
14626 Example :
14627 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14628 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14629 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14630 # send large files to the big farm
14631 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14632
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014633env(<name>) : string
14634 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14635 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14636 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14637 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14638 certain way.
14639
14640 Examples :
14641 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14642 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14643
14644 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14645 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14648 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014649 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14650 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14652 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014653 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14655 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014656
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014657fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14658 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14659 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14660 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14663 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14664 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14665 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14666 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14667 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14668 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14669 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14670 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014671
14672 Example :
14673 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14674 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14675 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14676 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14677 frontend mail
14678 bind :25
14679 mode tcp
14680 maxconn 100
14681 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14682 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14683 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14684 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014685
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014686hostname : string
14687 Returns the system hostname.
14688
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014689int(<integer>) : signed integer
14690 Returns a signed integer.
14691
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014692ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14693 Returns an ipv4.
14694
14695ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14696 Returns an ipv6.
14697
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014698lat_ns_avg : integer
14699 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14700 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14701 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14702 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14703 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14704 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14705 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14706 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14707 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14708 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14709 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14710 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14711 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14712 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14713
14714lat_ns_tot : integer
14715 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14716 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14717 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14718 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14719 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14720 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14721 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14722 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14723 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14724 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14725 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14726 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14727 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14728 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14729 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14730 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14731 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14732 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14733 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14734
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014735meth(<method>) : method
14736 Returns a method.
14737
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014738nbproc : integer
14739 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14740 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14741 and debugging purposes.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14744 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14745 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14746 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014747 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14748 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14749 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014750
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014751prio_class : integer
14752 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14753 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14754 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14755
14756prio_offset : integer
14757 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14758 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14759 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14760 set-priority-offset".
14761
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014762proc : integer
14763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14764 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14765 debugging purposes.
14766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014767queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014768 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14769 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14770 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14772 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14773 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14774 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14775 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14776
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014777rand([<range>]) : integer
14778 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14779 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14780 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14781 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14782 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14783
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014784uuid([<version>]) : string
14785 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14786 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14787 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14790 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14791 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14792 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14793 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14794 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014795 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14796 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14797
14798srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14799 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14800 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14801 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14802 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14803 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14804 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14805 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14806
14807 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14808 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809
14810srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14811 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14812 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14813 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14816 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14817 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14818
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014819srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14821 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14822 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14823 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14824 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14825 fetch methods.
14826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14828 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14829 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014830 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14832 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014833 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834 overloading servers).
14835
14836 Example :
14837 # Redirect to a separate back
14838 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14839 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14840 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14841
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014842stopping : boolean
14843 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14844 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14845 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14846
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014847str(<string>) : string
14848 Returns a string.
14849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14851 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14852 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14853
14854table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14855 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14856 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14857 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14858
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014859thread : integer
14860 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14861 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14862 and debugging purposes.
14863
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014864var(<var-name>) : undefined
14865 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014866 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14867 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014868 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014869 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14870 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014871 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014872 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14873 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014875 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014876
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148777.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878----------------------------------
14879
14880The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14881closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14882methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14883sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14884TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014885the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14886counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014887"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14888used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14889can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14890Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14891table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14892tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14893currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014895bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014896 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14897 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14898 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900be_id : integer
14901 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14902 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14903
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014904be_name : string
14905 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14906 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908dst : ip
14909 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14910 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14911 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14912 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014913 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14914 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14915 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14916 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14917 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14918 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919
14920dst_conn : integer
14921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14922 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14923 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14924 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14925 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14926 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14927 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14928 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014929
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014930dst_is_local : boolean
14931 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14932 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14933 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14934 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014935 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014936 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14937 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14938 it only once per connection.
14939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940dst_port : integer
14941 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14942 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14943 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14944 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14945 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14946 an HTTP header.
14947
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014948fc_http_major : integer
14949 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14950 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14951 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14952
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014953fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14954 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14955 header.
14956
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014957fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14958 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14959 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14960 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14961 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14962 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14963 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14964
14965fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14966 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14967 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14968 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14969 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14970 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14971 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14972
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014973fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014974 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14975 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14976 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14977 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14978
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014979fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014980 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14981 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14982 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14983 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14984
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014985fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014986 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14987 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14988 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14989 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14990
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014991fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014992 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14993 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14994 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14995 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14996
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014997fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014998 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14999 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15000 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15001 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15002
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015003fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015004 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15005 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15006 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15007 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15008
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015009fe_defbe : string
15010 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15011 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015013fe_id : integer
15014 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015015 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015016 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15017
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015018fe_name : string
15019 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15020 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15021 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015023sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015024sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15025sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15026sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015027 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15028 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15029 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15030
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015031sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015032sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15033sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15034sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015035 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15036 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15037 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15038
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015039sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015040sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15041sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15042sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015043 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15044 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015045 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15046 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15047 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015048
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015049 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015050 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15051 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015052 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15053 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15054 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015055 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15056 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15057
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015058sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15059sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15060sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15061sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15062 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15063 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15064 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15065 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15066 when a first ACL was verified.
15067
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015068sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015069sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15070sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15071sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015072 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015073 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15074
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015075sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015076sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15077sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15078sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015079 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15080 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15081 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015083sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015084sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15085sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15086sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015087 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15088 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15089 See also src_conn_rate.
15090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015091sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015092sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15093sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15094sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015095 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015096 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015097
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015098sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15099sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15100sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15101sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15102 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15103 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15104
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015105sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15106sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15107sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15108sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15109 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15110 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015112sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015113sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15114sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15115sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015116 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15117 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15118 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015119 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15120 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15121 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015122
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015123sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15124sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15125sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15126sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15127 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15128 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15129 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15130 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15131 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15132 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15133
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015134sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015135sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15136sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15137sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015138 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015139 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15140 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15141
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015142sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015143sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15144sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15145sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015146 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15147 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15148 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15149 src_http_err_rate.
15150
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015151sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015152sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15153sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15154sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015155 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015156 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15157 src_http_req_cnt.
15158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015159sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015160sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15161sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15162sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015163 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15164 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15165 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15166 src_http_req_rate.
15167
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015168sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015169sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15170sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15171sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015172 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015173 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15174 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15175 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15176 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015177
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015178 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015179 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15180 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015181 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15182
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015183sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15184sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15185sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15186sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15187 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15188 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15189 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15190 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15191 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15192
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015193sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015194sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15195sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15196sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015197 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15198 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15199 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015200
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015201sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015202sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15203sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15204sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015205 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15206 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15207 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015209sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015210sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15211sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15212sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015213 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015214 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15215 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15216 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015217 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015218 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15219
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015220sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015221sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15222sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15223sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015224 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15225 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15226 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15227 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15228 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015229 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015230
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015231sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015232sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15233sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15234sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015235 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15236 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15237 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15238
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015239sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015240sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15241sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15242sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015243 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15244 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015245 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015246 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15247 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15249 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15250 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015252so_id : integer
15253 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15254 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15255 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015257src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015258 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15260 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15261 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015262 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15263 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15264 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015265 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15266 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15267 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15268 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15269 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15270 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15271 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015272
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015273 Example:
15274 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15275 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15278 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15279 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15280 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015281 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015283src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15284 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15285 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015286 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015287 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15290 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15291 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15292 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15293 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15294 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15295 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015296
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015297 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015298 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15299 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15300 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15301 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015302 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015303 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15304 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15305
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015306src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15307 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15308 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15309 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15310 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15311 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15312 was verified.
15313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015317 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015318 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015321 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15323 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015324 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15327 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15328 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15329 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015330 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015333 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015335 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015336 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015337
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015338src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15339 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15340 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15341 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15342 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15343
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015344src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15345 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15346 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15347 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15348 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015351 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015352 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015353 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15354 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015355 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15356 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15357 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015358
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015359src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15360 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15361 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15362 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15363 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15364 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15365 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15366 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015369 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015371 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015372 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015375src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15376 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15377 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15378 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15379 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015380 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015382src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015383 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015384 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15385 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015386 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15389 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15390 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15391 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015392 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015393 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015395src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15396 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15397 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15398 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015399 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015400 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15401 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015402
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015403 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015404 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015405 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015406 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015407
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015408src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15409 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15410 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15411 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15412 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15413 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15414 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15415
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015416src_is_local : boolean
15417 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15418 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15419 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15420 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015421 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015422 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15423 once per connection.
15424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015425src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015426 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15427 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15428 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15429 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15430 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015433 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15434 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15435 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15436 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15437 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015439src_port : integer
15440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15441 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15442 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15443 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015445src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015446 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015447 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15448 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15449 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015450 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015452src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15453 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15454 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15455 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15456 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015457 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015459src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15460 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15461 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15462 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15463 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15464 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15465 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15466 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15467 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015468
15469 Example :
15470 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15471 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15472 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15473 listen ssh
15474 bind :22
15475 mode tcp
15476 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015477 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015479 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481srv_id : integer
15482 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15483 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15484 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015485
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154867.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15490closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15491when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15492usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015493future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015494
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001549551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15496 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15497 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15498 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15499 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15500 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15501
15502 Example :
15503 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15504 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15505 # the request.
15506 frontend http-in
15507 bind *:8081
15508 default_backend servers
15509 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15510 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15511
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015512ssl_bc : boolean
15513 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15514 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15515 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15516
15517ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15518 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15519 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15520
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015521ssl_bc_alpn : string
15522 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15523 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015524 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015525 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15526 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15527 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15528 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15529 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15530 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15531
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015532ssl_bc_cipher : string
15533 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15534 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15535
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015536ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15537 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15538 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15539 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15540
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015541ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15542 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15543 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15544 session or a TLS ticket.
15545
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015546ssl_bc_npn : string
15547 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15548 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015549 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015550 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15551 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15552 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15553 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15554 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15555
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015556ssl_bc_protocol : string
15557 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15558 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15559
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015560ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015561 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015562 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15563 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015564
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015565ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15566 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15567 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15568 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15569
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015570ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15571 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15572 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15573 if session was reused or not.
15574
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015575ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15576 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15577 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15578 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15579 BoringSSL.
15580
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015581ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15582 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15583 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15586 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15587 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15588 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15589 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15590 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015592ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15593 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15594 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15595 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15596 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015597
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015598ssl_c_der : binary
15599 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15600 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15601 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603ssl_c_err : integer
15604 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15605 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15606 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15607 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15608 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15611 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15612 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15613 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15614 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15615 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15616 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15617 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15618 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620ssl_c_key_alg : string
15621 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15622 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15623 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625ssl_c_notafter : string
15626 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15627 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15628 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630ssl_c_notbefore : string
15631 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15632 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15633 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15636 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15637 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15638 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15639 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15640 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15641 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15642 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15643 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645ssl_c_serial : binary
15646 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15647 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15648 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15651 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15652 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15653 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015654 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15655 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15656
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015657 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015658 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15661 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15662 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15663 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665ssl_c_used : boolean
15666 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15667 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669ssl_c_verify : integer
15670 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15671 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15672 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15673 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675ssl_c_version : integer
15676 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15677 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015678
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015679ssl_f_der : binary
15680 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15681 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15682 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15685 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15686 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15687 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15688 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015689 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15691 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15692 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694ssl_f_key_alg : string
15695 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15696 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15697 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699ssl_f_notafter : string
15700 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15701 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15702 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704ssl_f_notbefore : string
15705 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15706 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15707 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15710 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15711 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15712 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15713 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15714 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15715 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15716 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15717 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719ssl_f_serial : binary
15720 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15721 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15722 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015723
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015724ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15725 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15726 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15727 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15730 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15731 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15732 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734ssl_f_version : integer
15735 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15736 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15737
15738ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015739 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15740 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15741 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 Example :
15744 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15745 listen http-https
15746 bind :80
15747 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15748 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15749
15750ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15751 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15752 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15753
15754ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015755 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15757 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15758 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15759 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15760 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15761 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15762 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15763 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765ssl_fc_cipher : string
15766 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15767 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015768
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015769ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15770 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15771 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015772 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015773
15774ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15775 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15776 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015777 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015778
15779ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15780 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15781 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15782 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015783 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015784 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015785
15786ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15787 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15788 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015789 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015790
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015791ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15792 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15793 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15794 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015797 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15798 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015799 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15800 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15801 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15802 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015803
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015804ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15805 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15806 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15807 wait until the handshake happened.
15808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15810 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015811 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15812 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015813 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015814 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015815
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015816ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015817 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015818 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15819 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015821ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015822 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15824 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15825 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15826 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15827 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15828 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15829 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831ssl_fc_protocol : string
15832 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15833 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015834
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015835ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015836 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015837 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15838 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015839
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015840ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15841 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15842 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15843 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015845ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15846 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15847 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15848 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15849 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015850
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015851ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15852 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15853 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15854 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15855 BoringSSL.
15856
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858ssl_fc_sni : string
15859 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15860 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15861 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15862 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15863 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15864
15865 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15866 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15867 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015868 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015869 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15873 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015875ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15876 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15877 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015878
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015879
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15884sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15885only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15886For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15887be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15888can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15889sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15890for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15891content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015894 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015895 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15896 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15899 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015900 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015902
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015903req.hdrs : string
15904 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15905 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15906 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15907 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15908
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015909req.hdrs_bin : binary
15910 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15911 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15912 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15913 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15914 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15915 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15916
15917 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15918
15919 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15920 str: <int:length><bytes>
15921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922req.len : integer
15923req_len : integer (deprecated)
15924 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15925 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15926 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15927 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15928 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15929 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15930 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15931 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15934 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015935 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15936 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15937 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15938 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940 ACL alternatives :
15941 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15944 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15945 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15946 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15947 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949 ACL alternatives :
15950 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954req.proto_http : boolean
15955req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15956 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15957 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15958 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15959 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15960 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15961 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15962 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015964 Example:
15965 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15966 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15967 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015968 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015970req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15971rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15972 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15973 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15974 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15975 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15976 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15977 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15978 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015980 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15981 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15982 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15983 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15984 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15985 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 ACL derivatives :
15988 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990 Example :
15991 listen tse-farm
15992 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15993 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15994 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15995 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15996 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15997 persist rdp-cookie
15998 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15999 # This is only useful makes sense if
16000 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16001 stick-table type string size 204800
16002 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16003 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16004 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016006 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16007 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16010rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16011 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16012 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16013 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16014 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 ACL derivatives :
16017 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016018
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016019req.ssl_alpn : string
16020 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16021 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16022 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16023 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16024 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16025 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016026 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016027
16028 Examples :
16029 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16030 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16031 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016032 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016033 default_backend bk_default
16034
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016035req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16036 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16037 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016038 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16039 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16040 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16041 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16042 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16045req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16046 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16047 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16048 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16049 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16050 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16051 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16052 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054req.ssl_sni : string
16055req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16056 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16057 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16058 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16059 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16060 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16061 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16062 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16063 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16064 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16065 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16066 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16067 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069 ACL derivatives :
16070 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016072 Examples :
16073 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16074 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16075 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16076 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16077 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016078
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016079req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16080 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16081 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16082 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16083 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16084 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16085 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16086 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16087 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16088 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090req.ssl_ver : integer
16091req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16092 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16093 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16094 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16095 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16096 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16097 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16098 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016099 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102 ACL derivatives :
16103 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016104
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016105res.len : integer
16106 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16107 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16108 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16109 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16110 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16111 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16112 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16113 content inspection.
16114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16116 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016117 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16118 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16119 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16120 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016122res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16123 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16124 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16125 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16126 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016129
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016130res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16131rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16132 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16133 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16134 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16135 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16136 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16137 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16138 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140wait_end : boolean
16141 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16142 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016143 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16145 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016146 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16148 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150 Examples :
16151 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16152 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16153 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016155 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16156 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16157 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16158 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16159 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16160 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16161 tcp-request content reject
16162
16163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161647.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165--------------------------------------
16166
16167It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16168This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16169data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16170its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16171HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16172content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16173to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16174more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16175response are indexed.
16176
16177base : string
16178 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16179 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16180 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16181 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16182 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16183 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16184 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16185 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16186
16187 ACL derivatives :
16188 base : exact string match
16189 base_beg : prefix match
16190 base_dir : subdir match
16191 base_dom : domain match
16192 base_end : suffix match
16193 base_len : length match
16194 base_reg : regex match
16195 base_sub : substring match
16196
16197base32 : integer
16198 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16199 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16200 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016201 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16202 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16203 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016204
16205base32+src : binary
16206 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16207 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16208 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16209 per-URL counters.
16210
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016211capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16212 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16213 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16214 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16215
16216capture.req.method : string
16217 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16218 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16219 because it's allocated.
16220
16221capture.req.uri : string
16222 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16223 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16224 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16225 allocated.
16226
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016227capture.req.ver : string
16228 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16229 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16230 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16231
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016232capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16233 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16234 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16235 The first entry is an index of 0.
16236 See also: "capture response header"
16237
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016238capture.res.ver : string
16239 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16240 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16241 persistent flag.
16242
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016243req.body : binary
16244 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16245 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16246 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16247 the first chunk is analyzed.
16248
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016249req.body_param([<name>) : string
16250 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16251 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16252 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16253 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16254 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16255 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16256 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16257 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16258 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16259 given.
16260
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016261req.body_len : integer
16262 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16263 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16264 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16265 "option http-buffer-request".
16266
16267req.body_size : integer
16268 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16269 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16270 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16271 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16272 "option http-buffer-request".
16273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016274req.cook([<name>]) : string
16275cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16276 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16277 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16278 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16279 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16280 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16281 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16282 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16283 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16284
16285 ACL derivatives :
16286 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16287 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16288 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16289 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16290 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16291 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16292 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16293 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16296cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16297 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16298 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16301cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16302 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16303 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16304 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16305 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016307cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16308 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16309 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16310 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16311 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016312 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016313 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16314 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16315 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16316 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016318hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16319 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16320 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16321 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16322 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016323 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016325req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16326 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16327 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16328 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16329 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16330 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16331 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16332 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16333 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16336 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16337 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16338 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16339 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16342 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16343 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16344 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16345 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16346 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16347 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16348 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16349 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016350 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016351 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016352 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016354 ACL derivatives :
16355 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16356 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16357 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16358 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16359 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16360 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16361 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16362 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16363
16364req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16365hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16367 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16368 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16369 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16370 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16371 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16372 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16373 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16374 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16375
16376req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16377hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16378 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16379 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16380 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16381 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16382 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016383 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016384 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16385 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16386
16387req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16388hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16389 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16390 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16391 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16392 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16393 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16394 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16395 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16396
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016397
16398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016399http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16400 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16401 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16402 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16403 basic auth is supported.
16404
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016405http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16406 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16407 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16408 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16409 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016410 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16411 basic auth is supported.
16412
16413 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016414 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16415 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16416 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16417 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418
16419http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016420 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16421 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016422 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16423 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425method : integer + string
16426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16427 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16428 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16429 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16430 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16431 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16432 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016434 ACL derivatives :
16435 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437 Example :
16438 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16439 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16440 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442path : string
16443 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16444 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16445 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16446 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16447 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016448 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016451 ACL derivatives :
16452 path : exact string match
16453 path_beg : prefix match
16454 path_dir : subdir match
16455 path_dom : domain match
16456 path_end : suffix match
16457 path_len : length match
16458 path_reg : regex match
16459 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016460
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016461query : string
16462 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16463 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16464 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16465 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016466 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016467 which stops before the question mark.
16468
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016469req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16470 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16471 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16472 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16473 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016475req.ver : string
16476req_ver : string (deprecated)
16477 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16478 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16479 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016481 ACL derivatives :
16482 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016484res.comp : boolean
16485 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16486 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16487 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489res.comp_algo : string
16490 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16491 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16492 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494res.cook([<name>]) : string
16495scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16496 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16497 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16498 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500 ACL derivatives :
16501 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16504scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16505 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16506 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16507 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16510scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16511 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16512 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16513 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016515res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16516 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16517 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16518 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16519 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16520 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16521 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16522 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16523 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16524 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16527 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16528 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16529 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16530 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16531 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016533res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16534shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16535 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16536 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16537 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16538 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16539 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16540 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16541 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16542 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016544 ACL derivatives :
16545 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16546 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16547 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16548 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16549 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16550 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16551 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16552 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16553
16554res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16555shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16556 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16557 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16558 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16559 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16560 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16563shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16564 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16565 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16566 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16567 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16568 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16569 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016570
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016571res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16572 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16573 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16574 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16575 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016577res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16578shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16579 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16580 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16581 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16582 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16583 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16584 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586res.ver : string
16587resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16588 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16589 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591 ACL derivatives :
16592 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016594set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16595 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16596 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016597 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16601 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603status : integer
16604 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16605 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16606 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016607
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016608unique-id : string
16609 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16610 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16611 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16612 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16613 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16614 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616url : string
16617 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16618 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16619 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16620 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16621 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16622 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16623 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016625 ACL derivatives :
16626 url : exact string match
16627 url_beg : prefix match
16628 url_dir : subdir match
16629 url_dom : domain match
16630 url_end : suffix match
16631 url_len : length match
16632 url_reg : regex match
16633 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016635url_ip : ip
16636 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16637 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16638 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16639 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16640 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16641 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16642 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644url_port : integer
16645 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16646 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16647 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16648 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016649
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016650urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16651url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016652 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16653 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016654 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16655 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16656 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16657 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16659 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016660 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16661 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016663 ACL derivatives :
16664 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16665 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16666 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16667 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16668 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16669 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16670 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16671 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016672
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016674 Example :
16675 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16676 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16677 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16678 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016679
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016680urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016681 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16682 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16683 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016684
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016685url32 : integer
16686 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16687 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16688 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16689 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16690 is an unsigned integer.
16691
16692url32+src : binary
16693 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16694 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16695 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16696
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016699---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016701Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16702every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016703order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016705ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16706---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016707FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016708HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016709HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16710HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016711HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16712HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16713HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16714HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16715LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016716METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016717METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016718METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16719METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16720METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16721METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016722METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016723METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016724RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016725REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016726TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016727WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16728---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016729
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167318. Logging
16732----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016734One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16735provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16736very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16737provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16738state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016739to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016740headers.
16741
16742In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16743about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16744send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16745
16746 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16747 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16748 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16749 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16750 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016751 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016752 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016753
16754The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16755allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16756as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16757while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16758real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16759delay.
16760
16761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167628.1. Log levels
16763---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016764
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016765TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016767HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16768in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16769track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16770syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16771about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016772
16773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167748.2. Log formats
16775----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016776
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016777HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016778and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16779slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16780options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016781
16782 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16783 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16784 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16785 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16786 extents.
16787
16788 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16789 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16790 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16791 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16792 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16793
16794 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16795 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16796 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16797 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16798 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16799
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016800 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16801 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16802 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16803 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16804
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016805 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16806
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016807Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16808specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16809field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16810servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16811always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16812identifier.
16813
16814Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16815 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16816 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16817 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16818 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16819
16820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168218.2.1. Default log format
16822-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016823
16824This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16825as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16826format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16827
16828 Example :
16829 listen www
16830 mode http
16831 log global
16832 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16833
16834 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16835 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16836 (www/HTTP)
16837
16838 Field Format Extract from the example above
16839 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16840 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16841 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16842 4 'to' to
16843 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16844 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16845
16846Detailed fields description :
16847 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16848 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16849 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16850 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16851 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16852 and processed the connection.
16853 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16854
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016855In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16856"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16857connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16858
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016859It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16860will eventually disappear.
16861
16862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168638.2.2. TCP log format
16864---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016865
16866The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16867is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16868information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16869counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16870emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16871environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16872the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16873sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016874specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16875not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16876fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16877marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016878
16879 Example :
16880 frontend fnt
16881 mode tcp
16882 option tcplog
16883 log global
16884 default_backend bck
16885
16886 backend bck
16887 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16888
16889 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16890 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16891 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16892
16893 Field Format Extract from the example above
16894 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16895 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16896 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16897 4 frontend_name fnt
16898 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16899 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16900 7 bytes_read* 212
16901 8 termination_state --
16902 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16903 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16904
16905Detailed fields description :
16906 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016907 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16908 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16909 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016910 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016911 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016912 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016913
16914 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016915 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16916 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16917 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016918
16919 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16920 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16921 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016922 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16923 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16924 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16925 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016926
16927 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16928 and processed the connection.
16929
16930 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16931 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16932 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16933 applications.
16934
16935 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16936 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16937 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16938 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16939 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16940
16941 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16942 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16943 See "Timers" below for more details.
16944
16945 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16946 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16947 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16948 "Timers" below for more details.
16949
16950 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016951 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016952 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16953 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16954 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16955 details.
16956
16957 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16958 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16959 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16960 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16961 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16962
16963 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16964 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16965 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16966 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16967 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16968 for more details.
16969
16970 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016971 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016972 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16973 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16974 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016975 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016976
16977 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16978 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16979 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16980 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16981 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16982 caused by a denial of service attack.
16983
16984 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16985 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16986 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16987 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16988 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16989 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16990 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16991 denial of service attack.
16992
16993 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16994 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16995 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16996 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16997 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16998 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16999 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17000 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17001 be processed than on other servers.
17002
17003 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17004 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17005 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17006 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17007 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17008 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17009 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17010 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17011 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17012 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17013 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17014 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17015 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17016
17017 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17018 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17019 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17020 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17021 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17022 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017023 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017024 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17025
17026 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17027 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17028 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17029 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17030 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17031 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017032 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17034 occurs.
17035
17036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170378.2.3. HTTP log format
17038----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039
17040The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17041is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17042the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17043are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17044emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17045generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17046"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17047which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017048frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17049is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017050
17051Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17052slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17053with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17054
17055 Example :
17056 frontend http-in
17057 mode http
17058 option httplog
17059 log global
17060 default_backend bck
17061
17062 backend static
17063 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17064
17065 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17066 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17067 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017068 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017069
17070 Field Format Extract from the example above
17071 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17072 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017073 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017074 4 frontend_name http-in
17075 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017076 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017077 7 status_code 200
17078 8 bytes_read* 2750
17079 9 captured_request_cookie -
17080 10 captured_response_cookie -
17081 11 termination_state ----
17082 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17083 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17084 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17085 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17086 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017087
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017088Detailed fields description :
17089 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017090 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17091 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17092 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017093 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017094 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017095 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
17097 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017098 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17099 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17100 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017101
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017102 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17103 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017104
17105 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17106 and processed the connection.
17107
17108 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17109 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17110 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17111
17112 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17113 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17114 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17115 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17116 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17117 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17118
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017119 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17120 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17121 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017122 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017123 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17124 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017125 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17126 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017127
17128 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17129 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017130 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017131
17132 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17133 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017134 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17135 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017136
17137 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17138 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17139 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17140 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17141 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017142 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17143 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017145 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17146 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17147 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17148 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17149 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17150 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17151 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017152 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017153
17154 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17155 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17156 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17157
17158 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17159 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017160 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017161 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17162 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17163 overflowing.
17164
17165 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17166 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17167 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17168 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17169 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17170 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17171 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17172 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17173
17174 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17175 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17176 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17177 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17178 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17179 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17180 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17181 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17182
17183 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17184 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17185 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17186 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17187 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17188 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17189 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17190
17191 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017192 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017193 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17194 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17195 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017196 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017197 system.
17198
17199 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17200 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17201 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17202 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17203 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17204 caused by a denial of service attack.
17205
17206 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17207 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17208 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17209 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17210 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17211 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17212 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17213 denial of service attack.
17214
17215 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17216 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17217 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17218 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17219 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17220 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17221 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17222 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17223 processed than on other servers.
17224
17225 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17226 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17227 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17228 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17229 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17230 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17231 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17232 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17233 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17234 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17235 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17236 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17237 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17238
17239 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17240 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17241 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17242 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17243 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17244 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017245 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017246 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17247
17248 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17249 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17250 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17251 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17252 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17253 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017254 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17256 occurs.
17257
17258 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17259 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17260 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17261 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17262 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17263 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17264 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17265 cookies" below for more details.
17266
17267 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17268 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17269 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17270 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17271 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17272 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17273 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17274 and cookies" below for more details.
17275
17276 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17277 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17278 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17279 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17280 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17281 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17282 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17283 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17284
17285
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172868.2.4. Custom log format
17287------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017288
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017289The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017290mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017292HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017293Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17294separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17295prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17296
17297Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17298variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017299("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017300
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017301If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017302as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017303less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17304the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17305
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017306Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017307In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017308in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017309
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017310Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17311'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17312https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17313such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17314
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017315Flags are :
17316 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017317 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017318 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17319 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017320
17321 Example:
17322
17323 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17324 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17325
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017326 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17327
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017328At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17329
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017330 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17331 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017332
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017333the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017334
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017335 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17336 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17337 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017338
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017339and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17340
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017341 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17342 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017343
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017344Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17345
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017346 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017347 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017348 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17349 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17350 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017351 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17352 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17353 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017354 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017355 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17356 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017357 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017358 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17359 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017360 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017361 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017362 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017363 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017364 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017365 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017366 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017367 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17368 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17369 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17370 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17371 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017372 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017373 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17374 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017375 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017376 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17377 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017378 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17379 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17380 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017381 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017382 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17383 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017384 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017385 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17386 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17387 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017388 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017389 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017390 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17391 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17392 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17393 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017394 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017395 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017396 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017397 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017398 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017399 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017400 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17401 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17402 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017403 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017404 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17405 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017406 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017407 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17408 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017409 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017410 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017411 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017412 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017413
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017414 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017415
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017416
174178.2.5. Error log format
17418-----------------------
17419
17420When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17421protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17422By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17423"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017424will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017425logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17426
17427The format looks like this :
17428
17429 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17430 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17431 Connection error during SSL handshake
17432
17433 Field Format Extract from the example above
17434 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17435 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17436 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17437 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17438 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17439
17440These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17441failures.
17442
17443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174448.3. Advanced logging options
17445-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017446
17447Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17448just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17449options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17450for more information about their usage.
17451
17452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17454------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017455
17456It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17457haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17458commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17459monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17460ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17461
17462 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17463 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17464 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17465 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17466
17467 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17468 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17469 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017470 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017471 such as other load-balancers.
17472
17473 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17474 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17475 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17476
17477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17479----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017480
17481The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17482what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17483or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017484"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17486log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17487after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17488is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17489with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17490with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17491
17492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17494------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017495
17496Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17497for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17498"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17499retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17500raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17501a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17502file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17503you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17504"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17505
17506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17508--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017509
17510Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17511multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17512them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17513"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17514logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17515error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17516and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17517too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17518useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17519alternative.
17520
17521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175228.4. Timing events
17523------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017524
17525Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17526reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17527the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17528frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017529mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17530addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17531
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017532Timings events in HTTP mode:
17533
17534 first request 2nd request
17535 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17536 t tr t tr ...
17537 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17538 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17539 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17540 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17541 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17542
17543Timings events in TCP mode:
17544
17545 TCP session
17546 |<----------------->|
17547 t t
17548 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17549 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17550 |<------ Tt ------->|
17551
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017552 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017553 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017554 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17555 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17556 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017557 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017558 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17559 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17560 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17561 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017562
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017563 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17564 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17565 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017566 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17567 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17568 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17569 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17570 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17571 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017572
17573 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17574 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17575 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17576 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17577 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17578 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17579 request typed by hand during a test.
17580
17581 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17582 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017583 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017584 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17585 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17586 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17587 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017588
17589 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17590 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17591 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17592 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17593 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17594
17595 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17596 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17597 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17598 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17599 connection never established.
17600
17601 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17602 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17603 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17604 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17605 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17606 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17607 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17608 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17609 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17610 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17611 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17612
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017613 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17614 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17615 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17616 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17617 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17618 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17619
17620 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17621
17622 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17623 "Ta" can never be negative.
17624
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017625 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17626 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017627 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17628 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017629 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017631 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632
17633 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017634 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17635 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017636
17637These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17638protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17639that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017640due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17641"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17642that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643
17644Most common cases :
17645
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017646 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17647 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17648 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17649 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17650 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17651 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17652 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17653 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17654 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17655 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17656 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017657 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017658
17659 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17660 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17661 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17662 of ms on remote networks.
17663
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017664 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17665 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17666 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017667
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017668 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17669 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17670 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17671 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17672 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17673 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17674 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17675 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17676 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017677
17678Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17679
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017680 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017681 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017682 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017683
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017684 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017685 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17686 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17687
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017688 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017689 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17690 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17691 flags.
17692
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017693 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17694 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017695 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17696 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17697 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17698 the client connection was maintained open.
17699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017700 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017701 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017702 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17704
17705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177068.5. Session state at disconnection
17707-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017708
17709TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17710"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
177112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17712each of which has a special meaning :
17713
17714 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17715 session to terminate :
17716
17717 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17718
17719 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17720 server explicitly refused it.
17721
17722 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17723 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17724 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17725 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017726 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017727
17728 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17729 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017730
17731 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17732 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17733 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17734 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17735 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17736
17737 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17738 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17739 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17740 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17741 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17742
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017743 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17744 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17745
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017746 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17747 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17748 backup connections when going up.
17749
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017750 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17751
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017752 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17753 send or receive data.
17754
17755 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17756 send or receive data.
17757
17758 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17759 with nothing left in the buffers.
17760
17761 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17762
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017763 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017764 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17765
17766 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17767 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17768 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17769 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17770 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17771
17772 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17773 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17774
17775 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17776 server (HTTP only).
17777
17778 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17779
17780 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17781 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17782 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17783
17784 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17785 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17786 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17787
17788 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17789
17790 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17791 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17792
17793 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17794 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17795 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17796
17797 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17798 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017799 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17800 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017801
17802 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17803 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17804 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17805 another server.
17806
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017807 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017808 server.
17809
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017810 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17811 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17812 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17813 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17814
17815 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17816 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17817 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17818 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17819
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017820 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17821 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17822 "use-server" rule).
17823
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017824 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17825
17826 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17827 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17828
17829 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17830
17831 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17832 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17833 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17834
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017835 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17836 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017837 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017838 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17839 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17840
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017841 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17842
17843 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17844 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17845
17846 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17847
17848 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17849
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017850The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17851was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017852helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17853starvation, attacks, etc...
17854
17855The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17856alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17857easier finding and understanding.
17858
17859 Flags Reason
17860
17861 -- Normal termination.
17862
17863 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17864 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17865 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17866 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17867
17868 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17869 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17870 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17871 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17872 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17873 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017874
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017875 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17876 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017877 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017878
17879 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17880 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17881 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17882
17883 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17884 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17885 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17886 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17887 the server takes too long to respond.
17888
17889 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17890 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17891 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17892 long a time to respond.
17893
17894 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17895 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17896 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17897 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017898 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17899 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017900
17901 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17902 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17903 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17904 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17905 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017906 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017907 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17908 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17909 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17910 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17911 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17912 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17913 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17914 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017915 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017916 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17917 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17918 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017919
17920 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17921 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017922 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17923 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17924 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17925 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017927 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17928 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017930 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017931 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17932 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017933 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17935 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17936
17937 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17938 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17939 503 or 504 here.
17940
17941 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17942 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17943 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17944 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17945 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17946
17947 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17948 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017949 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017950 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17951 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17952
17953 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17954 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17955 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17956 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17957 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17958 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17959 between haproxy and the server.
17960
17961 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17962 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17963 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17964 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17965 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17966 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17967 solution is to fix the application.
17968
17969 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17970 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17971 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17972 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17973 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17974 external attacks.
17975
17976 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17977 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017978 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17980 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17981
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017982 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17983 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17984 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017985 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017986 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017987
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017988 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17989 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17990 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17991 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017992 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17993 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17994 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17995 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17996 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017997
17998 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17999 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18000 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18001 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18002
18003 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18004 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18005 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18006 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18007
18008 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18009 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18010 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18011 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18012
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018013The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18014persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18015important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18016re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18017
18018 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18019
18020 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18021 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18022 set on a GET request.
18023
18024 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18025 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018026 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018027 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18028
18029 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18030 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18031 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18032
18033 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18034 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18035 already got a cookie.
18036
18037 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18038 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18039 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18040 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18041 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18042
18043 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18044 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18045 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18046
18047 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18048 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18049 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18050
18051 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18052 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18053
18054 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18055 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18056 then advertised in the response.
18057
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180598.6. Non-printable characters
18060-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018061
18062In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18063consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18064converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18065prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18066being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18067escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18068is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18069'}' when logging headers.
18070
18071Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18072issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18073containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18074
18075Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18076the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18077performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18078
18079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18081---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018082
18083Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18084achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018085section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018086cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18087the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18088the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018089locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018090not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18091user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18092a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18093wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18094
18095 Examples :
18096 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18097 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18098
18099 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18100 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18101
18102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18104---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018105
18106Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18107proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18108the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18109server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18110
18111Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18112response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018113section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114
18115It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018116time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18117appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018118are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18119and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18120follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18121request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18122in the logs.
18123
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018124As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18125frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18126an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18127
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018128 Example :
18129 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18130 listen proxy-out
18131 mode http
18132 option httplog
18133 option logasap
18134 log global
18135 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18136
18137 # log the name of the virtual server
18138 capture request header Host len 20
18139
18140 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18141 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18142
18143 # log the beginning of the referrer
18144 capture request header Referer len 20
18145
18146 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18147 capture response header Server len 20
18148
18149 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18150 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18151
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018152 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018153 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18154
18155 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18156 capture response header Via len 20
18157
18158 # log the URL location during a redirection
18159 capture response header Location len 20
18160
18161 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18162 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18163 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18164 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18165 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18166
18167 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18168 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18169 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18170 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018171 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018172
18173 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18174 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18175 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18176 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18177 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018178 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018179
18180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181818.9. Examples of logs
18182---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018183
18184These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18185them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18186reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18187
18188 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18189 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18190 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18191
18192 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18193 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18194
18195 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18196 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18197 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18198
18199 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18200 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18201
18202 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18203 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18204 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18205
18206 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018207 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018208 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18209 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18210
18211 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18212 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18213 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18214
18215 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18216 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018217 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018218 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18219 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18220 to return the 502 and not the server.
18221
18222 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018223 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018224
18225 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18226 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18227 Nothing was sent to any server.
18228
18229 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18230 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18231
18232 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18233 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018235 send a 408 return code to the client.
18236
18237 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18238 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18239
18240 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18241 5 seconds ("c----").
18242
18243 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18244 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018245 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018246
18247 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018248 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018249 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18250 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18251 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18252 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18253 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018254
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018255
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200182569. Supported filters
18257--------------------
18258
18259Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18260accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18261unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18262
18263See also : "filter"
18264
182659.1. Trace
18266----------
18267
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018268filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018269
18270 Arguments:
18271 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18272 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18273
18274 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18275 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18276 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18277 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18278
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018279 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018280 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18281 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18282 amount of the parsed data.
18283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018284 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018285
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018286This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18287callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18288information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18289filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18290
18291Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18292tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18293a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18294
18295
182969.2. HTTP compression
18297---------------------
18298
18299filter compression
18300
18301The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18302keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018303when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18304it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18305response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18306line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18307cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18308the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018309
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018310See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018311
18312
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200183139.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18314--------------------------------------------
18315
18316filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18317
18318 Arguments :
18319
18320 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18321 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18322 parsed.
18323
18324 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18325 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18326 part must be placed in its own scope.
18327
18328The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18329external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018330streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018331exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18332also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18333
18334SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18335the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18336
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018337For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018338"doc/SPOE.txt".
18339
18340Important note:
18341 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18342 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18343
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100183449.4. Cache
18345----------
18346
18347filter cache <name>
18348
18349 Arguments :
18350
18351 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18352
18353The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18354"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018355cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018356other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18357the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18358mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18359filter other than the compression is used for the same
18360listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18361order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018362
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018363See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018364
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001836510. Cache
18366---------
18367
18368HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18369(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18370RAM.
18371
18372The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018373this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018374
18375If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18376independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18377when we try to allocate a new one.
18378
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018379The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018380
18381It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18382"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18383for more details.
18384
18385When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18386replaced by "<CACHE>".
18387
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001838810.1. Limitation
18389----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018390
18391The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18392
18393- If the response is not a 200
18394- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018395- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018396- If the response is not cacheable
18397
18398- If the request is not a GET
18399- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018400- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018401
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018402Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18403filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18404can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18405example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18406"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018407
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001840810.2. Setup
18409-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018410
18411To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18412the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18413
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001841410.2.1. Cache section
18415---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018416
18417cache <name>
18418 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18419 size of cache is mandatory.
18420
18421total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018422 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018423 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018424
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018425max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018426 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18427 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18428 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018429
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018430max-age <seconds>
18431 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18432 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18433 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18434 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18435 default.
18436
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001843710.2.2. Proxy section
18438---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018439
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018440http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018441 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18442 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18443 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18444 after this one.
18445
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018446http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018447 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18448 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18449 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18450 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18451
18452
18453Example:
18454
18455 backend bck1
18456 mode http
18457
18458 http-request cache-use foobar
18459 http-response cache-store foobar
18460 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18461
18462 cache foobar
18463 total-max-size 4
18464 max-age 240
18465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018466/*
18467 * Local variables:
18468 * fill-column: 79
18469 * End:
18470 */